01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001...

325
This Owner’s Manual should be considered a permanent part of the car, and should remain with the car when it is sold. This Owner’s Manual covers all models of the Civic 4-door. You may find descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your particular model. The information and specifications included in this publication were in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd. reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications or design at any time without notice and without incurring any obligation whatsoever. Owner’s Identification Si prefiere este Manual del Propietario en español, comuníquese con el concesionario Honda. POUR CLIENTS CANADIEN AVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avez besoin d’un Manuel du Conducteur en français, veuillez demander à votre concessionnaire de commander le numéro de pièce 33S5AC10 OWNER ADDRESS V. I. N. DELIVERY DATE DEALER NAME DEALER NO. ADDRESS OWNER’S SIGNATURE DEALER’S SIGNATURE STREET CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/ POSTAL CODE (Date sold to original retail purchaser) STREET CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/ POSTAL CODE

Transcript of 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001...

Page 1: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This Owner’s Manual should be considereda permanent part of the car, and shouldremain with the car when it is sold.

This Owner’s Manual covers all models ofthe Civic 4-door. You may find descriptionsof equipment and features that are not onyour particular model.

The information and specifications includedin this publication were in effect at the timeof approval for printing. Honda Motor Co.,Ltd. reserves the right, however, todiscontinue or change specifications ordesign at any time without notice andwithout incurring any obligation whatsoever.

Owner’s Identif ication

Si prefiere este Manual delPropietario en español,comuníquese con el concesionarioHonda.

POUR CLIENTS CANADIENAVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avezbesoin d’un Manuel du Conducteuren français, veuillez demander àvotre concessionnaire decommander le numéro de pièce33S5AC10

OWNER

ADDRESS

V. I. N.

DELIVERY DATE

DEALER NAME DEALER NO.

ADDRESS

OWNER’S SIGNATURE

DEALER’S SIGNATURE

STREET

CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE

(Date sold to original retail purchaser)

STREET

CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE

01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001

Page 2: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Several warranties protect your new Honda. Read the warranty bookletthoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rightsand responsibilities.

As you read this manual, you willfind information that is preceded bya symbol. Thisinformation is intended to help youavoid damage to your Honda, otherproperty, or the environment.

One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new Honda is toread this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls andconvenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your car so youcan refer to it at any time.

Maintaining your car according to the schedules given in this manual helpsto keep your driving trouble-free while it preserves your investment. Whenyour car needs maintenance, keep in mind that your Honda dealer’s staff isspecially trained in servicing the many systems unique to your Honda. YourHonda dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will be pleased to answerany questions and concerns.

Congratulations Your selection of a 2002 Honda Civic was a wiseinvestment. It will give you years of driving pleasure.

California Proposition 65 Warning

This product contains or emits chemicals known to the State ofCalifornia to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm.

Introduction

WARNING:

i

01/06/02 16:43:43 31S5A610_002

Page 3: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To help you make informeddecisions about safety, we haveprovided operating procedures andother information on labels and inthis manual. This information alertsyou to potential hazards that couldhurt you or others.

You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,including:

These signal words mean:

preceded by a safety alert symbol and one ofthree signal words: , , or .

such as Driver and Passenger Safety.

This entire book is filled with important safety information please read itcarefully.

such as Important Safety Reminders or ImportantSafety Precautions.

Your safety, and the safety of others,is very important. And operating thiscar safely is an importantresponsibility.

Of course, it is not practical orpossible to warn you about all thehazards associated with operating ormaintaining your car. You must useyour own good judgement.

on the car.

how to use this car correctly and safely.

A Few Words About Safety

Safety Messages

Safety Section

Safety Headings

Safety Labels

Instructions

DANGER WARNING CAUTION

ii

You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.

You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.

You CAN be HURT if you don’t followinstructions.

01/06/02 16:43:56 31S5A610_003

Page 4: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Turn to the beginning of each section for a complete list of subjects.

ID numbers, dimensions, capaci-ties, and technical information.

How to order manuals and othertechnical literature.

A summary of the warrantiescovering your new Honda, andhow to contact us for any reason.Refer to your warranty manual fordetailed information.

Important information about theproper use and care of your car’sseat belts, an overview of theSupplemental Restraint System,and valuable information on howto protect children with childrestraints.

Explains the purpose of eachinstrument panel indicator andgauge, and how to use the controlson the dashboard and steeringcolumn.

A summary of information you needwhen you pull up to the fuel pump.

How to operate the heating and airconditioning system, the audiosystem, and other conveniencefeatures.

What gasoline to use, how to

break-in your new car, and how toload luggage and other cargo.

The proper way to start the engine,shift the transmission, and park.

The Maintenance Schedule showsyou when you need to take yourcar to the dealer. There is also alist of things to check andinstructions on how to check them.

Tips on cleaning and protectingyour car. Also some things to lookfor if your car ever needs bodyrepairs.

This section covers severalproblems motorists sometimesexperience, and details how tohandle them.

Contents

...............Your Car at a Glance . 2

....Driver and Passenger Safety . 5

.....................................Index . I

Service Information Summary

.....Instruments and Controls . 57

Comfort and Convenience............................Features . 105

...................Before Driving . 163

..............................Driving . 177

......................Maintenance . 195

................Appearance Care . 257

Taking Care of the.......................Unexpected . 265

.........Technical Information . 293

Warranty and CustomerRelations

........(U.S. and Canada only) . 307

Authorized Manuals.........................(U.S. only) . 311

1

01/06/02 16:44:18 31S5A610_004

Page 5: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your Car at a Glance

2

AAIIRRBBAAGGSS

FFUUEELL FFIILLLL DDOOOORR RREELLEEAASSEE

TTRRUUNNKK RREELLEEAASSEE

AAUUTTOOMMAATTIICC TTRRAANNSSMMIISSSSIIOONN

MMAANNUUAALL TTRRAANNSSMMIISSSSIIOONN

HHEEAATTIINNGG//CCOOOOLLIINNGG CCOONNTTRROOLLSS

AAUUDDIIOO SSYYSSTTEEMM

DDIIGGIITTAALL CCLLOOCCKK

((PP.. 111144,, 112266,, 113388))

((PP.. 111199,, 113311,, 114433))

((PP.. 110066))

PPOOWWEERRDDOOOORR LLOOCCKKSSWWIITTCCHH

HHOOOODD RREELLEEAASSEEHHAANNDDLLEE

PPOOWWEERR WWIINNDDOOWWSSWWIITTCCHHEESS

((PP.. 1100,, 4488))

((PP.. 8822))

((PP.. 9933))

((PP.. 116655))

((PP.. 8866)) ((PP.. 116666))((PP.. 118822))

((PP.. 118800))

01/06/02 16:44:22 31S5A610_005

Page 6: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your Car at a Glance

3

MMIIRRRROORR CCOONNTTRROOLLSS

MMOOOONNRROOOOFF

TTIILLTT AADDJJUUSSTTMMEENNTT

HHEEAADDLLIIGGHHTTSS//TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALLSS

WWIINNDDSSHHIIEELLDD WWIIPPEERRSS//WWAASSHHEERRSS

HHAAZZAARRDD WWAARRNNIINNGG LLIIGGHHTTSS((PP.. 7700,, 7722)) ((PP.. 7744))

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWWDDEEFFOOGGGGEERR

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLL SSWWIITTCCHHEESS

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLLMMAASSTTEERR SSWWIITTCCHH

((PP.. 7722,, 7744))

((PP.. 9955))

((PP.. 115599))

((PP.. 9966)) ((PP.. 7766)) ((PP.. 116600))

((PP.. 7755))

01/06/02 16:44:27 31S5A610_006

Page 7: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

4

01/06/02 16:44:29 31S5A610_007

Page 8: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This section gives you importantinformation about how to protectyourself and your passengers. Itshows you how to use seat beltsproperly. It explains your Supple-mental Restraint System. And it tellsyou how to properly restrain infantsand children in your car.

.........Important Safety Precautions . 6.............Your Car’s Safety Features . 7

.......................................Seat Belts . 8.........................................Airbags . 10

.....................Seats & Seat-Backs . 11..........................Head Restraints . 11

..................................Door Locks . 11........Pre-Drive Safety Checklist . 12

............................Protecting Adults . 13.....1. Close and Lock the Doors . 13

...........2. Adjust the Front Seats . 13............3. Adjust the Seat-Backs . 15

...4. Adjust the Head Restraints . 165. Fasten and Position the Seat

.....................................Belts . 16....6. Adjust the Steering Wheel . 18

7. Maintain a Proper Sitting................................Position . 19

.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 20...Additional Safety Precautions . 20

........................Protecting Children . 22All Children Must Be

...............................Restrained . 22Children Should Sit in the Back

...........................................Seat . 23The Passenger’s Front Airbag

Poses Serious Risks to...............................Children . 23

If You Must Drive with Several...................................Children . 25

If a Child Requires Close..................................Attention . 26

...Additional Safety Precautions . 26General Guidelines for Using

...............................Child Seats . 27.......................Protecting Infants . 31

.........Protecting Small Children . 35.......Protecting Larger Children . 38

Using Child Seats with.....................................Tethers . 42

.............................Using LATCH . 43Additional Information About Your

.................................Seat Belts . 45..Seat Belt System Components . 45

......................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 45Automatic Seat Belt

...............................Tensioners . 46...............Seat Belt Maintenance . 47

Additional Information About...........................Your Airbags . 48

........................SRS Components . 48How Your Front Airbags

.........................................Work . 48...How Your Side Airbags Work . 50

How the SRS Indicator Light.......................................Works . 51

How the Side Airbag Cut-off...........Indicator Light Works . 52

.............................Airbag Service . 53...Additional Safety Precautions . 53

.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 54...................................Safety Labels . 55

Driver and Passenger Safety

Driver and Passenger Safety

5

01/06/02 16:44:35 31S5A610_008

Page 9: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Excessive speed is a major factor incrash injuries and deaths. Generally,the higher the speed the greater therisk, but serious accidents can alsooccur at lower speeds. Never drivefaster than is safe for currentconditions, regardless of themaximum speed posted.

While airbags can save lives, theycan cause serious or fatal injuries tooccupants who sit too close to them,or are not properly restrained.Infants, young children, and shortadults are at the greatest risk. Besure to follow all instructions andwarnings in this manual. (See page

.)

Having a tire blowout or amechanical failure can be extremelyhazardous. To reduce the possibilityof such problems, check your tirepressures and condition frequently,and perform all regularly scheduledmaintenance. (See page .)

You’ll find many safetyrecommendations throughout thissection, and throughout this manual.The recommendations on this pageare the ones we consider to be themost important.

A seat belt is your best protection inall types of collisions. Airbagssupplement seat belts, but airbagsare designed to inflate only in amoderate to severe frontal collision.So even though your car is equippedwith airbags, make sure you andyour passengers always wear yourseat belts, and wear them properly.(See page .)

Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Evenone drink can reduce your ability torespond to changing conditions, andyour reaction time gets worse withevery additional drink. So don’t drinkand drive, and don’t let your friendsdrink and drive, either.

Children are safest when they areproperly restrained in the back seat,not the front seat. A child who is toosmall for a seat belt must be properlyrestrained in a child safety seat. (Seepage .)

16

22

10

200

Driver and Passenger Safety

Important Safety Precautions

Always Wear Your Seat Belt

Be Aware of Airbag Hazards Control Your Speed

Restrain All Children

Keep Your Car in Safe ConditionDon’t Drink and Drive

6

01/06/02 16:44:49 31S5A610_009

Page 10: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your car is equipped with manyfeatures that work together toprotect you and your passengersduring a crash.

Some safety features do not requireany action on your part. Theseinclude a strong steel frameworkthat forms a safety cage around thepassenger compartment; front andrear crush zones that are designed tocrumple and absorb energy during acrash; a collapsible steering column;and seat belt tensioners thatautomatically tighten the front seatbelts in the event of a crash.

CONTINUED

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your Car’s Safety Features

7

((44))

((55))

((66))

((22))

((88))

((99))

((88))

((77))

((1100)) ((11)) ((33))

((22))

((77))

((11)) SSaaffeettyy CCaaggee((22)) CCrruusshh ZZoonnee((33)) SSeeaattss && SSeeaatt--BBaacckkss((44)) HHeeaadd RReessttrraaiinnttss((55)) CCoollllaappssiibbllee SStteeeerriinngg CCoolluummnn((66)) SSeeaatt BBeellttss((77)) FFrroonntt AAiirrbbaaggss((88)) SSiiddee AAiirrbbaaggss

((OOppttiioonnaall oonn UU..SS.. mmooddeellss oonnllyy))((99)) SSeeaatt BBeelltt TTeennssiioonneerrss((1100)) DDoooorr LLoocckkss

01/06/02 16:44:59 31S5A610_010

Page 11: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

For your safety, and the safety ofyour passengers, your car isequipped with seat belts in all seatingpositions.

These safety features are designedto reduce the severity of injuries in acrash. However, you and yourpassengers can’t take full advantageof these safety features unless youremain sitting in a proper positionand

In fact, some safetyfeatures can contribute to injuries ifthey are not used properly.

Your seat belt system alsoincludes a light on the

instrument panel to remind you andyour passengers to fasten your seatbelts.

Seat belts are the single mosteffective safety device for adults andlarger children. (Infants and smallerchildren must be properly restrainedin child seats.)

Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your car has airbags.

In addition, most states and allCanadian provinces require you towear seat belts.

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your Car’s Safety Features

Seat Belts

always wear your seat beltsproperly.

Why Wear Seat Belts

8

01/06/02 16:45:08 31S5A610_011

Page 12: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When properly worn, seat belts:

Help protect you in almost everytype of crash, including frontal,side, and rear impacts androllovers.

Help keep you from being thrownagainst the inside of the vehicleand against other occupants.

Keep you from being thrown outof the vehicle.

Help keep you in a good positionshould the airbags ever deploy. Agood position reduces the risk ofinjury from an inflating airbag, andallows you to get the bestadvantage from the airbag.

Of course, seat belts cannotcompletely protect you in everycrash. But in most cases, seat beltscan reduce your risk of seriousinjury.

Always wearyour seat belt, and make sure youwear it properly.

Keep you connected to the vehicleso you can take advantage of thevehicle’s built-in safety features.

What you should do:

Your Car’s Safety Features

Driver and Passenger Safety 9

Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, evenif you have airbags.

Be sure you and yourpassengers always wear seatbelts and wear them properly.

01/06/02 16:45:19 31S5A610_012

Page 13: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your car has a SupplementalRestraint System (SRS) with frontairbags to help protect the heads andchests of the driver and a front seatpassenger during a moderate tosevere frontal collision.

Your car also has side airbags to helpprotect the upper torso of the driveror a front seat passenger during amoderate to severe side impact.

The most important things you needto know about your airbags are:

Always wearyour seat belt properly, and situpright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel ordashboard.

To do their job, airbags mustinflate with tremendous force andspeed. So while airbags help savelives, they can cause minor injuries,or more serious or even fatalinjuries if occupants are notproperly restrained or sittingproperly.

They are designed to supplementthe seat belts.

Only on U.S. models equipped with sideairbags.

Airbags

Your Car’s Safety Features

Driver and Passenger Safety

What you should do:

Airbags can pose serious hazards.

Airbags offer no protection in rearimpacts, rollovers, or minorfrontal or side collisions.

Airbags do not replace seat belts.

10

01/06/02 16:45:31 31S5A610_013

Page 14: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

How you adjust your seats and seat-backs can also affect your safety. Forexample, sitting too close to thesteering wheel or dashboardincreases the risk of you or yourpassenger being injured by strikingthe inside of the car, or by aninflating airbag.

Reclining a seat-back too far reducesthe seat belt’s effectiveness andincreases the chance that the seat’soccupant will slide under the seatbelt in a crash and be seriouslyinjured.

Head restraints can help protect youfrom whiplash and other injuries. Formaximum protection, the back ofyour head should rest against thecenter of the head restraint.

Your car’s seats are designed to keepyou in a comfortable, uprightposition so you can take fulladvantage of the protection offeredby seat belts and the energyabsorbing materials in the seats.

Move the frontseats as far back as possible, andkeep adjustable seat-backs in anupright position whenever the car ismoving.

Keeping your doors locked reducesthe chance of being thrown out ofthe car during a crash. It also helpsprevent occupants from accidentallyopening a door and falling out, andoutsiders from unexpectedly openingyour doors.

Seats & Seat-Backs

Head Restraints

Door LocksWhat you should do:

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your Car’s Safety Features

11

01/06/02 16:45:41 31S5A610_014

Page 15: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

All adults, and children who haveoutgrown child safety seats, arewearing their seat belts andwearing them properly (see page

).

Any infant or small child isproperly restrained in a child seatin the back seat (see page ).

To make sure you and yourpassengers get the maximumprotection from your car’s safetyfeatures, check the following eachtime before you drive away:

The rest of this section gives moredetailed information about how youcan maximize your safety.

Remember, however, that no safetysystem can prevent all injuries ordeaths that can occur in severecrashes, even when seat belts areproperly worn and the airbags deploy.

All cargo is properly stored orsecured (see page ).

All doors are closed and locked(see page ).

Head restraints are properlyadjusted (see page ).

Seat-backs are upright (see page).

Front seat occupants are sittingupright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel anddashboard (see page ).

16

13

13

22

15

16

173

Pre-Drive Safety Checklist

Your Car’s Safety Features

Driver and Passenger Safety12

01/06/02 16:45:53 31S5A610_015

Page 16: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The following pages provideinstructions on how to properlyprotect the driver and other adultoccupants.

These instructions also apply tochildren who have outgrown childseats and are large enough to wearlap/shoulder belts. (See page forimportant additional guidelines onhow to properly protect largerchildren.)

Any driver who sits too close to thesteering wheel is at risk of beingseriously injured or killed by strikingthe steering wheel or from beingstruck by an inflating front airbagduring a crash.

After everyone has entered the car,be sure the doors are closed andlocked.

For safety, locking the doors reducesthe chance that a passenger,especially a child, will open a doorwhile the car is moving andaccidentally fall out. It also reducesthe chance of someone being thrownout of the car during a crash.

For security, locked doors canprevent an outsider fromunexpectedly opening a door whenyou come to a stop.

See page for how to lock thedoors.

38

81

CONTINUED

Introduction Adjust the Front SeatsClose and Lock the Doors1. 2.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety 13

01/06/02 16:46:05 31S5A610_016

Page 17: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

See page for how to adjust thefront seats.

Once your seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make surethe seat is locked in position.

Most shorter drivers can get farenough away from the steeringwheel and still reach the pedals.However, if you are concerned aboutsitting too close, we recommend thatyou investigate whether some typeof adaptive equipment may help.

To reduce the chance of injury, wearyour seat belt properly, sit uprightwith your back against the seat, andmove the seat away from thesteering wheel to the farthestdistance that allows you to maintainfull control of the car.

The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that driversadjust the seat so the center of thechest is at least 10 inches (25 cm)away from the center of the steeringwheel. Also make sure your frontseat passenger moves the seat as farto the rear as possible.

88

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety14

Sitting too close to a frontairbag can result in seriousinjury or death if the frontairbags inflate.

Always sit as far back from thefront airbags as possible.

01/06/02 16:46:14 31S5A610_017

Page 18: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

See page for how to adjust seat-backs.

A front passenger should also adjustthe seat-back to an upright position,but as far from the dashboard aspossible. A passenger who sits tooclose to the dashboard could beinjured if the front airbag inflates.

Reclining a seat-back so that theshoulder part of the belt no longerrests against the occupant’s chestreduces the protective capability ofthe belt. It also increases the chanceof sliding under the belt in a crashand being seriously injured. Thefarther a seat-back is reclined, thegreater the risk of injury.

Adjust the driver’s seat-back to acomfortable, upright position,leaving ample space between yourchest and the airbag cover in thecenter of the steering wheel. If yousit too close to the steering wheel,you could be injured if the frontairbag inflates.

88

Adjust the Seat-Backs3.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety 15

Reclining the seat-back too farcan result in serious injury ordeath in a crash.

Adjust the seat-back to anupright position and sit wellback in the seat.

01/06/02 16:46:22 31S5A610_018

Page 19: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Before driving, make sure everyonewith an adjustable head restraint hasproperly positioned the headrestraint. The restraint should bepositioned so the back of theoccupant’s head rests against thecenter of the restraint. A tallerperson should adjust the restraint ashigh as possible.

Properly adjusted head restraintswill help protect occupants fromwhiplash and other crash injuries.

See page for how to adjust thehead restraints.

Insert the latch plate into the buckle,then tug on the belt to make sure thebelt is securely latched. Also checkthat the belt is not twisted, because atwisted belt can cause seriousinjuries in a crash.

90

Adjust the Head Restraints Fasten and Position the SeatBelts

4. 5.

Driver and Passenger Safety

Protecting Adults

16

Improperly positioning headrestraints reduces theireffectiveness and you can beseriously injured in a crash.

Make sure head restraints arein place and positioned properlybefore driving.

01/06/02 16:46:33 31S5A610_019

Page 20: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Position the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across your hips,then pull up on the shoulder part ofthe belt so the lap part fits snugly.This lets your strong pelvic bonestake the force of a crash and reducesthe chance of internal injuries.

If necessary, pull up on the belt againto remove any slack from theshoulder part, then check that thebelt rests across the center of yourchest and over your shoulder. Thisspreads the forces of a crash overthe strongest bones in your upperbody.

If the seat belt touches or crossesyour neck, or if it crosses your arminstead of your shoulder, you need toadjust the seat belt anchor height.

To adjust the height of a front seatbelt anchor, squeeze the two releasebuttons and slide the anchor up ordown as needed (it has fourpositions).

CONTINUED

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety 17

Improperly positioning the seatbelts can cause serious injuryor death in a crash.

Make sure all seat belts areproperly positioned beforedriving.

01/06/02 16:46:42 31S5A610_020

Page 21: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Adjust the steering wheel, if needed,so that the wheel points toward yourchest, not toward your face.

Pointing the steering wheel towardyour chest provides optimalprotection from the airbag.

See page for how to adjust thesteering wheel.

If a seat belt does not seem to workas it should, it may not protect theoccupant in a crash.

Anyone using a seat belt that isnot working properly can beseriously injured or killed. Have yourHonda dealer check the belt as soonas possible.

See page for additionalinformation about your seat beltsystem and how to take care of yourbelts.

This could causevery serious injuries in a crash.

45

76

Adjust the Steering Wheel6.

No one shouldsit in a seat with an inoperative seatbelt.

Never place the shoulder portion of alap/shoulder belt under your arm orbehind your back.

Driver and Passenger Safety

Protecting Adults

18

01/06/02 16:46:51 31S5A610_021

Page 22: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

After all occupants have adjustedtheir seats and put on seat belts, it isvery important that they continue tosit upright, well back in their seats,with their feet on the floor, until thecar is parked and the engine is off.

Sitting improperly can increase thechance of injury during a crash. Forexample, if an occupant slouches,lies down, turns sideways, sitsforward, leans forward or sideways,or puts one or both feet up, thechance of injury during a crash isgreatly increased.

In addition, an occupant who is out ofposition in the front seat can beseriously or fatally injured bystriking interior parts of the car, orby being struck by an inflating frontairbag. Being struck by an inflatingside airbag can result in possiblyserious injuries.

Remember, to get the bestprotection from your car’s airbagsand other safety features, you mustsit properly and wear your seat beltproperly.

Maintain a Proper SittingPosition

7.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety 19

Sitting improperly or out ofposition can result in seriousinjury or death in a crash.

Always sit upright, well back inthe seat, with your feet on thefloor.

01/06/02 16:46:59 31S5A610_022

Page 23: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Because protecting the mother is thebest way to protect her unborn child,a pregnant woman should alwayswear a seat belt whenever she drivesor rides in a vehicle.

Remember to keep the lap portion ofthe belt as low as possible acrossyour hips.

Pregnant women should also situpright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel ordashboard. This will reduce the riskof injuries to both the mother andher unborn child that can be causedby a crash or an inflating airbag.

Each time you have a check-up, askyour doctor if it’s okay for you todrive.

If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.

Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt canseverely compromise theprotective capability of the seatbelt and increase the chance ofserious injury in a crash.

Advice for Pregnant Women Additional Safety PrecautionsTwo people should never use thesame seat belt.

Do not put any accessories on seatbelts.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety20

01/06/02 16:47:10 31S5A610_023

Page 24: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Carrying hard or sharpobjects on your lap, or driving witha pipe or other sharp object inyour mouth, can result in injuriesif your front airbag inflates.

Any objectattached to or placed on the coversmarked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’ in thecenter of the steering wheel andon top of the dashboard couldinterfere with the proper operationof the airbags. Or, if the airbagsinflate, the objects could bepropelled inside the car and hurtsomeone.

If yourhands or arms are close to theairbag cover in the center of thesteering wheel or on top of thedashboard, they could be injured ifthe front airbags inflate.

If a side airbaginflates, a cup holder or other hardobject attached on or near thedoor could be propelled inside thecar and hurt someone.

Do not place hard or sharp objectsbetween yourself and a frontairbag.

Do not attach or place objects onthe front airbag covers.

Keep your hands and arms awayfrom the airbag covers.

On U.S. models with side airbags,do not attach hard objects on ornear a front door.

Protecting Adults

Driver and Passenger Safety 21

01/06/02 16:47:17 31S5A610_024

Page 25: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

(See page.)

To reduce the number of childdeaths and injuries, every state andCanadian province requires thatinfants and children be restrainedwhenever they ride in a vehicle.

Each year, many children are injuredor killed in vehicle crashes becausethey are either unrestrained or notproperly restrained. In fact, vehicleaccidents are the number one causeof death of children ages 12 andunder.

Children depend on adults to protectthem. However, despite their bestintentions, many parents and otheradults may not know how toprotect young passengers.

So if you have children, or if you everneed to drive with a grandchild orother children in your car, be sure toread this section.

(See page.)

27

38

properly

All Children Must Be Restrained

Any child who is too small to wear aseat belt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat.

A larger child should always berestrained with a seat belt.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety22

Children who are unrestrainedor improperly restrained can beseriously injured or killed in acrash.

Any child too small for a seatbelt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat. Alarger child should be properlyrestrained with a seat belt.

01/06/02 16:47:28 31S5A610_025

Page 26: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Front airbags have been designed tohelp protect adults in a moderate tosevere frontal collision. To do this,the passenger’s front airbag is quitelarge, and it inflates with tremendousspeed.

Ifthe airbag inflates, it can hit the backof the child seat with enough forceto kill or very seriously injure aninfant.

According to accident statistics,children of all ages and sizes aresafer when they are restrained in theback seat, not the front seat. TheNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenages 12 and under be properlyrestrained in the back seat.

In the back seat, children are lesslikely to be injured by striking hardinterior parts during a collision orhard braking. Also, children cannotbe injured by an inflating airbagwhen they ride in the back.

If you are not wearing aseat belt in a crash, you could bethrown forward into thedashboard and crush the child.

If you are wearing a seat belt, thechild can be torn from your armsduring a crash. For example, ifyour car crashes into a parkedvehicle at 30 mph (48 km/h), a20-lb (9 kg) infant will become a600-lb (275 kg) force, and you willnot be able to hold on.

During acrash, the belt could press deepinto the child and cause veryserious injuries.

CONTINUED

The Passenger’s Front AirbagPoses Serious Risks to Children

Children Should Sit in the BackSeat

InfantsNever put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag.

Additional Precautions to ParentsNever hold an infant or child onyour lap.

Never put a seat belt over yourselfand an infant or child.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 23

01/06/02 16:47:41 31S5A610_026

Page 27: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To remind you of the passenger’sfront airbag hazards, and thatchildren must be properly restrainedin the back seat, your car haswarning labels on the dashboard andon the driver’s and front passenger’svisors. Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.

Whenever possible,larger children should sit in the backseat, properly restrained with a seatbelt. (See page for importantinformation about protecting largerchildren.)

If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to kill orvery seriously injure a small child.

38

U.S. ModelsSmall Children

Children who have outgrown childseats are also at risk of being injuredor killed by an inflating passenger’sfront airbag.

Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.

Larger Children

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety24

01/06/02 16:47:52 31S5A610_027

Page 28: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To remind you of the front airbaghazards, your car has warning labelson the driver’s and front passenger’svisors. Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.

Your car has three seating positionsin the back seat where children canbe properly restrained.

If you ever have to carry more thanthree children in your car:

Place the largest child in the frontseat, provided the child is largeenough to wear a seat beltproperly (see page ).

Move the vehicle seat as far to therear as possible (see page ).

Have the child sit upright and wellback in the seat (see page ).

Make sure the seat belt is properlypositioned and secured (see page

).

38

13

19

16

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

If You Must Drive with SeveralChildren

Canadian Models

25

01/06/02 16:48:07 31S5A610_028

Page 29: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Even very youngchildren learn how to unlockvehicle doors, turn on the ignition,and open the trunk, which canlead to accidental injury or death.

Childrenwho play in cars can accidentallyget trapped inside the trunk.Teach your children not to play inor around cars. Know how tooperate the emergency trunkopener (U.S. models only) anddecide if your children should beshown how to use this feature (seepage ).

Leaving children withoutadult supervision is illegal in moststates and Canadian provinces,and can be very hazardous. Forexample, infants and smallchildren left in a vehicle on a hotday can die from heatstroke. Andchildren left alone with the key in

the ignition can accidentally setthe vehicle in motion, possiblyinjuring themselves or others.

Using this feature willprevent children from opening thedoors and accidentally falling out(see page ).

Usingthis feature will prevent childrenfrom playing with the windows,which could expose them tohazards or distract the driver (seepage ).

Many parents say they prefer to putan infant or small child in the frontpassenger seat so they can watch thechild, or because the child requiresattention.

Placing a child in the front seatexposes the child to hazards fromthe passenger’s front airbag, andpaying close attention to a childdistracts the driver from theimportant tasks of driving, placingboth of you at risk.

If a child requires physical attentionor frequent visual contact, westrongly recommend that anotheradult ride with the child in the backseat. The back seat is far safer for achild than the front.

87

86

94

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Keep car keys and remotetransmitters out of the reach ofchildren.

Lock all doors and the trunk whenyour vehicle is not in use.

Do not leave children alone in yourvehicle.

Use childproof door locks toprevent children from opening thedoors.

Use the main power windowswitch to prevent children fromopening the rear windows.

Additional Safety PrecautionsIf a Child Requires CloseAttention

26

01/06/02 16:48:19 31S5A610_029

Page 30: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The following pages give generalguidelines for selecting and installingchild seats for infants and smallchildren.

To provide proper protection, a childseat should meet threerequirements:

The child seat shouldmeet Federal Motor VehicleSafety Standard 213 (FMVSS 213)or Canadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandard 213 (CMVSS 213). Lookfor the manufacturer’s statementof compliance on the box and seat.

Children up to about oneyear old should be restrained in arear-facing, reclining child seat. Onlya rear-facing seat provides theproper support to protect an infant’shead, neck, and back. See page

for additional information onprotecting infants.31

CONTINUED

General Guidelines for UsingChild Seats

Selecting a Child Seat

The child seat should meet safetystandards.

The child seat should be of theproper type and size to fit the child.

Infants:2.

1.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 27

01/06/02 16:48:30 31S5A610_030

Page 31: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Before purchasing a child seat, werecommend that parents test thechild seat in the specific vehicleseating position (or positions) wherethey intend to use the seat. If apreviously purchased child seat doesnot fit, you may need to buy adifferent one that will fit.

Due to variations in the design ofchild seats, vehicle seats, and seatbelts, all child seats will not fit allvehicle seating positions.

A child who is toolarge for a rear-facing child seat, andwho can sit up without support,should be restrained in a forward-facing child seat. See page foradditional information on protectingsmall children.

However, Honda is confident thatone or more child seat models can fitand be properly installed in allrecommended seating positions inyour car.

Your car has lower anchors installedfor use with LATCH (LowerAnchors and Tethers for Children) -compatible child seats. For moreinformation, see page .

35

43

The child seat should fit thevehicle seating position (orpositions) where it will be used.

Small Children:

3.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety28

01/06/02 16:48:40 31S5A610_031

Page 32: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This page briefly summarizesHonda’s recommendations on whereto place rear-facing and forward-facing child seats in your car.

Never in the front seat, dueto the front airbag hazard.

The passenger’s front airbaginflates with enough force to killor seriously injure an infant in arear-facing child seat.

A small child in a forward-facingchild seat is also at risk. If thevehicle seat is too far forward,or the child’s head is thrownforward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can kill orseriously injure the child.

If a small child must ride in thefront, follow the instructionsprovided in this section.

Recommended positions.Properly secure a rear-facing childseat (see page ).

Not recommended,due to the front airbag hazard. If asmall child must ride in front,move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position and secure aforward-facing child seat with theseat belt (see page ).

Recommendedpositions. Properly secure aforward-facing child seat(see page ).

36

32

36CONTINUED

Placing a Child Seat Front Passenger’s SeatInfants:

Back SeatsInfants:

Small children:

Small children:

Airbags Pose SeriousRisks to Children

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 29

01/06/02 16:48:54 31S5A610_032

Page 33: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

After selecting a proper child seat,and a good position to install the seat,there are three main steps ininstalling the seat:

Make sure the child is properlystrapped in the child seataccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions. A child who is notproperly secured in a child seatcan be thrown out of the seat in acrash and be seriously injured.

To provide security during normaldriving maneuvers as well as duringa collision, we recommend thatparents secure a child seat as firmlyas possible.

If the child seat is not secure, tryinstalling it in a different seatingposition, or use a different style ofchild seat that can be firmly securedin the desired seating position.

When you are not using a child seat,either remove it and store it in a safeplace, or make sure it is properlysecured. An unsecured child seat canbe thrown around the car during acrash or sudden stop and injuresomeone.

However, a child seat does not needto be ‘‘rock solid.’’ In some vehiclesor seating positions, it may bedifficult to install a child seat so thatit does not move at all. Some side-to-side or back-and-forth movement canbe expected and should not reducethe child seat’s effectiveness.

After installing a childseat, push and pull the seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure.

All child seats aredesigned to be secured to the carwith the lap part of a lap/shoulderbelt. Some child seats can besecured to the vehicle’s LATCHanchorage system instead. A childwhose seat is not properly securedto the car can be endangered in acrash. See pages , and forinstructions on how to properlysecure child seats in this car.

4332 36

Installing a Child Seat Secure the child in the child seat.

Storing a Child Seat

Make sure the child seat is firmlysecured.

Properly secure the child seat tothe car.

1.

2.

3.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety30

01/06/02 16:49:06 31S5A610_033

Page 34: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Only a rear-facing child seat providesproper support for a baby’s head,neck, and back. Infants up to aboutone year of age must be restrained ina rear-facing child seat.

In this car, a rear-facing child seatcan be placed in any seating positionin the back seat, but not in the frontseat.

Two types of seats may be used: aseat designed exclusively for infants,or a convertible seat used in the rear-facing, reclining mode.

We recommend that an infant berestrained in a rear-facing child seatuntil the infant reaches the seatmaker’s weight or height limit and isable to sit up without support.

If the passenger’sfront airbag inflates, it can hit theback of the child seat with enoughforce to kill or seriously injure aninfant. If an infant must be closelywatched, we recommend thatanother adult sit in the back seatwith the baby.

If placedfacing forward, an infant could bevery seriously injured during afrontal collision.

CONTINUED

Protecting Infants

Child Seat Type

Rear-Facing Child Seat Placement

Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat.

Do not put a rear-facing child seat ina forward-facing position.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 31

Placing a rear-facing child seatin the front seat can result inserious injury or death if thepassenger’s front airbag inflates.

Always place a rear-facing childseat in the back seat, not thefront.

01/06/02 16:49:18 31S5A610_034

Page 35: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

With the child seat in the desiredback seating position, route thebelt through the child seataccording to the seat maker’sinstructions, then insert the latchplate into the buckle.

The lap/shoulder belts in the backseats have a locking mechanism thatmust be activated to secure a childseat.

The following pages provideinstructions and tips on how tosecure a rear-facing child seat withthis type of seat belt.

When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent thedriver or a front-seat passenger frommoving the seat as far back asrecommended (see page ). Or itmay prevent them from locking theseat-back in the desired uprightposition (see page ).

In either case, we recommend thatyou place the child seat directlybehind the front passenger seat,move the front seat as far forward asneeded, and leave it unoccupied. Oryou may wish to get a smaller childseat that allows you to safely carry afront passenger.

If you have a child seat designed tobe attached to the vehicle’s LATCHanchorage system, follow theinstructions on page .

1.

13

15

43

Rear-Facing Child Seat Installation

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety32

01/06/02 16:49:28 31S5A610_035

Page 36: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.

After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure.To remove slack, it may help toput weight on the child seat, orpush on the back of the seat, whilepulling up on the belt.

To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor (you might hear aclicking noise as the belt retracts).

After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked andyou will need to repeat these steps.

4. 5.2.

3.

CONTINUED

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 33

01/06/02 16:49:38 31S5A610_036

Page 37: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

For proper protection, an infant mustride in a reclined, or semi-reclinedposition. To determine the properreclining angle, check with the baby’sdoctor or follow the seat maker’srecommendations.

To achieve the desired recliningangle, it may help to put a rolled uptowel under the toe of the child seat,as shown.

To deactivate the lockingmechanism and remove a child seat,unlatch the buckle, unroute the seatbelt, and let the belt fully retract.

Rear-Facing Child Seat InstallationTips

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety34

01/06/02 16:49:45 31S5A610_037

Page 38: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

A child who can sit up withoutsupport, and who fits within the childseat maker’s weight and heightlimits, should be restrained in aforward-facing, upright child seat.

In this car, the best place to install aforward-facing child seat is in one ofthe seating positions in the back seat.

If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to causevery serious or fatal injuries. If asmall child must be closely watched,we recommend that another adult sitin the back seat with the child.

We also recommend that a smallchild stay in the child seat as long aspossible, until the child reaches theweight or height limit for the seat.

Of the different seats available, werecommend those that have a five-point harness system as shown.

CONTINUED

Protecting Small Children

Child Seat Type

Child Seat Placement

Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 35

01/06/02 16:49:56 31S5A610_038

Page 39: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

With the child seat in the desiredseating position, route the beltthrough the child seat accordingto the seat maker’s instructions,then insert the latch plate into thebuckle.

The lap/shoulder belts in the backand front passenger seating positionshave a locking mechanism that mustbe activated to secure a child seat.

The following pages provideinstructions on how to secure aforward-facing child seat with thistype of seat belt.

If it is necessary to put a forward-facing child seat in the front, movethe vehicle seat as far to the rear aspossible, be sure the child seat isfirmly secured to the car, and thechild is properly strapped in the seat.

If you have a child seat designed tobe attached to the vehicle’s LATCHanchorage system, follow theinstructions on page .

1.43

Child Seat Installation

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety36

Improperly placing a forward-facing child seat in the frontseat can result in serious injuryor death if the front airbagsinflate.

If you must place a forward-facing child seat in front, movethe vehicle seat as far back aspossible and properly restrainthe child.

01/06/02 16:50:07 31S5A610_039

Page 40: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.

After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure. Itmay help to put weight on thechild seat, or push on the back ofthe seat, while pulling up on thebelt.

To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor (you might hear aclicking noise as the belt retracts).

After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked andyou will need to repeat these steps.

4. 5.2.

3.

CONTINUED

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 37

01/06/02 16:50:16 31S5A610_040

Page 41: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When a child reaches therecommended weight or height limitfor a forward-facing child seat, thechild should sit in the back seat andwear a lap/shoulder belt.

If a child is too short for the shoulderpart of the belt to properly fit, werecommend that the child use abooster seat until the child is tallenough to use the seat belt without abooster.

The following pages giveinstructions on how to check properseat belt fit, what kind of boosterseat to use if one is needed, andimportant precautions for a childwho must sit in the front seat.

To deactivate the lockingmechanism in order to remove achild seat, unlatch the buckle,unroute the seat belt, and let the beltfully retract.

Protecting Larger Children

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety38

Allowing a larger child to sitimproperly in the front seat canresult in injury or death if thepassenger’s front airbag inflates.

If a larger child must sit in front,make sure the child moves theseat as far back as possibleand wears the seat belt properly.

01/06/02 16:50:24 31S5A610_041

Page 42: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt, severelycompromise the protective capabilityof the seat belt and increase thechance of serious injury in a crash.

If they do, they couldbe very seriously injured in a crash.

However, if the belt touches orcrosses the child’s neck, the childneeds to use a booster seat.

This could result inserious neck injuries during a crash.

This could causevery serious injuries during a crash.It also increases the chance that thechild will slide under the belt in acrash and be injured.To determine if a lap/shoulder belt

properly fits a child, have the childput on the seat belt. Follow theinstructions on page . Then checkhow the belt fits.

If the shoulder part of the belt restsover the child’s collarbone andagainst the center of the chest, asshown, the child is large enough towear the seat belt.

16

CONTINUED

Do not put any accessories on a seatbelt.

Two children should never use thesame seat belt.

Do not let a child wear a seat beltacross the neck.

Do not let a child put the shoulderpart of a seat belt behind the back orunder the arm.

Checking Seat Belt Fit

Driver and Passenger Safety

Protecting Children

39

01/06/02 16:50:35 31S5A610_042

Page 43: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The back seat is the safest place fora child of any age or size.

In addition, the passenger’s frontairbag poses serious risks to children.If the seat is too far forward, or thechild’s head is thrown forwardduring a collision, or the child isunrestrained or out of position, aninflating front airbag can kill orseriously injure the child.

The side airbag also poses risks. Ifany part of a larger child’s body is inthe path of a deploying airbag, thechild could receive possibly seriousinjuries.

A child may continue using a boosterseat until the tops of the ears areeven with the top of the seat-back. Achild of this height should be tallenough to use the lap/shoulder beltwithout a booster.

If a child needs a booster seat, werecommend choosing a style thatallows the child to use the lap/shoulder belt directly, without ashield, as shown.

Whichever style you select, followthe booster seat maker’s instructions.

The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenages 12 and under be properlyrestrained in the back seat.

Using a Booster Seat When Can a Larger Child Sit in Front

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety40

01/06/02 16:50:46 31S5A610_043

Page 44: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Of course, children vary widely. Andwhile age may be one indicator ofwhen a child can safely ride in thefront, there are other importantfactors you should consider.

Check that the child’s seat belt isproperly positioned and secured.

Have the child sit up straight, backagainst the seat, and feet on ornear the floor.

Move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position.

Carefully read the owner’s manualand make sure you understand allseat belt instructions and all safetyinformation.

If you decide that a child can safelyride up front, be sure to:

Supervise the child. Even maturechildren sometimes need to bereminded to fasten the seat beltsor sit properly.

Physically, a child must be largeenough for the lap/shoulder belt toproperly fit over the hips, chest, andshoulder (see pages and ). Ifthe seat belt does not fit properly,the child should not sit in the front.

To safely ride in front, a child mustbe able to follow the rules, includingsitting properly and wearing the seatbelt properly throughout a ride.

16 39

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety

Maturity

Physical Size

41

01/06/02 16:50:58 31S5A610_044

Page 45: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your car has three tether anchoragepoints under the rear window forsecuring a tether-style child seat tothe car.

The tether anchorage points arelocated under plastic covers. Pivotthe cover backward to access theanchorage point.

Attach the tether strap hook to thetether anchorage point as shown inthe illustration, then tighten thestrap according to the child seatmaker’s instructions. Make sure thestrap is not twisted.Since a tether can provide additional

security, we recommend using atether whenever one is required oravailable. (Tethers are required inCanada.)

Using Child Seats with Tethers

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety42

CCOOVVEERR

AANNCCHHOORRAAGGEE PPOOIINNTT

01/06/02 16:51:07 31S5A610_045

Page 46: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your car is equipped with LATCH(Lower Anchors and Tethers forChildren) at the outer rear seats.The lower anchors are locatedbetween the seat-back and seatbottom and are to be used only witha child seat designed for use withLATCH.

The exact location of each loweranchor is marked with a small circleabove the lower anchor point.

To install a LATCH-compatible childseat:

Move the seat belt buckle orcenter seat belt away from thelower anchors.

Make sure there are no foreignobjects around the anchors.Foreign objects could get in theway of a secure connectionbetween the child seat and theanchors.

Put the child seat in the rear leftor right vehicle seat and attach thechild seat to the lower anchorsaccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions.

1.

2.

3.

CONTINUED

Using LATCH

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety 43

RRiiggiidd ttyyppeeLLOOWWEERR AANNCCHHOORRSS

01/06/02 16:51:18 31S5A610_046

Page 47: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Follow the child seat maker’sinstructions for any additionaladvice on adjusting or tighteningthe fit.

Attach the tether strap hook to thetether anchorage point and tightenthe strap according to the childseat maker’s instructions. Makesure the strap is not twisted.

Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers.

4. 5.

6.

Protecting Children

Driver and Passenger Safety44

FFlleexxiibbllee ttyyppee

01/06/02 16:51:26 31S5A610_047

Page 48: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This seat belt has a single belt thatgoes over your shoulder, across yourchest and across your hips. The seat belts in all seating positions

except the driver’s have an additionallocking mechanism that must beactivated to secure a child seat. (Seepages and for instructions onhow to secure child seats with thistype of seat belt.)

All seat belts have an emergencylocking retractor. In normal driving,the retractor lets you move freely inyour seat while it keeps sometension on the belt. During a collisionor sudden stop, the retractorautomatically locks the belt to helprestrain your body.

Guide the belt across your body tothe door pillar. After exiting the car,be sure the belt is out of the way andwill not get closed in the door.

To unlock the belt, push the redPRESS button on the buckle.

To fasten the belt, insert the latchplate into the buckle, then tug on thebelt to make sure the buckle islatched.

The seat belt system alsoincludes a light on the

instrument panel to remind you andyour passengers to fasten your belts.If the driver’s seat belt is notfastened before the ignition is turnedON (II), the light will come on and abeeper will also sound. The beeperwill stop after a few seconds, but thelight will stay on until the driver’sseat belt is fastened.

Your seat belt system includes lap/shoulder belts in all five seatingpositions. The front seat belts arealso equipped with automatic seatbelt tensioners.

32 36

CONTINUED

Seat Belt System Components Lap/Shoulder Belt

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

Driver and Passenger Safety 45

01/06/02 16:51:38 31S5A610_048

Page 49: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If the shoulder part of the belt ispulled all the way out, the lockingmechanism will activate. The beltwill retract, but it will not allow thepassenger to move freely.

To deactivate the lockingmechanism, unlatch the buckle andlet the seat belt fully retract. Torefasten the belt, pull it out only asfar as needed.

See page for instructions on howto wear the lap/shoulder beltproperly.

The tensioners are designed toactivate primarily in frontal collisions.The tensioners are independent ofthe airbag system, so they can beactivated during a collision thatmight not cause the airbags todeploy. In this case, the airbagswould not be needed but theadditional seat belt tension can behelpful.

The tensioners will be activated in acollision severe enough to cause thefront airbags to inflate.

For added protection, the front seatbelts are equipped with automaticseat belt tensioners. When activated,the tensioners immediately tightenthe belts to help hold the driver anda front passenger in place.

When the tensioners are activated,the seat belts will remain tight untilthey are unbuckled in the normalway.

The SRS indicator light willcome on if there is a

problem with your automatic seatbelt tensioners (see page ).

16

51

Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

Driver and Passenger Safety46

01/06/02 16:51:49 31S5A610_049

Page 50: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

For safety, you should check thecondition of your seat belts regularly.

Pull each belt out fully and look forfrays, cuts, burns, and wear. Checkthat the latches work smoothly andthat the lap/shoulder belts retracteasily. Any belt not in good conditionor not working properly will notprovide good protection and shouldbe replaced as soon as possible.

Honda provides a lifetime warrantyon seat belts. Honda will repair orreplace any seat belt component thatfails to function properly duringnormal use. Please see your

booklet fordetails.

If a seat belt is worn during a crash,it must be replaced by the dealer. Abelt that has been worn during acrash may not provide the same levelof protection in a subsequent crash.The dealer should also inspect theanchors for damage and replacethem if needed.

Automatic seat belt tensioners thatdeployed during a crash must bereplaced.

For information on how to clean yourseat belts, see page .261

HondaWarranty Information

Seat Belt Maintenance

U.S. Models

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

Driver and Passenger Safety 47

Not checking or maintainingseat belts can result in seriousinjury or death if the seat beltsdo not work properly whenneeded.

Check your seat belts regularlyand have any problemcorrected as soon as possible.

01/06/02 16:52:01 31S5A610_050

Page 51: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your Supplemental Restraint System(SRS) includes:

Two front airbags. The driver’sairbag is stored in the center ofthe steering wheel; the frontpassenger’s airbag is stored in thedashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRSAIRBAG.’’

If you ever have a moderate tosevere frontal collision, the sensorswill detect the vehicle’s rapiddeceleration. If the rate ofdeceleration is high enough, thecontrol unit will instantly inflate thefront airbags.

A sophisticated electronic systemthat continually monitors andrecords information about thesensors, the control unit, theairbag activators, and driver andpassenger seat belt use when theignition is ON (II).

Sensors that can detect amoderate to severe frontalcollision.

Automatic seat belt tensioners(see page ).

An indicator light on theinstrument panel that alerts you toa possible problem with thesystem (see page ).

Emergency backup power in caseyour car’s electrical system isdisconnected in a crash.

5146

SRS Components How Your Front Airbags Work

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety48

01/06/02 16:52:14 31S5A610_051

Page 52: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This can occur when the severity ofa collision is at the margin, orthreshold, that determines whetheror not the airbags will deploy. Insuch cases, the seat belt will providesufficient protection, and thesupplemental protection offered bythe airbag would be minimal.

Since both airbags use the samesensors, both airbags normallyinflate at the same time. However, itis possible for only one airbag toinflate.

After inflating, the front airbagsimmediately deflate, so they won’tinterfere with the driver’s visibility,or the ability to steer or operateother controls.

During a frontal crash, your seatbelts help restrain your lower bodyand torso. Your airbag provides acushion to help restrain and protectyour head and chest.

The total time for inflation anddeflation is approximately one-tenthof a second, so fast that mostoccupants are not aware that theairbags deployed until they see themlying in their laps.

After a crash, you may see whatlooks like smoke. This is actuallypowder from the airbag’s surface.Although the powder is not harmful,people with respiratory problemsmay experience some temporarydiscomfort. If this occurs, get out ofthe car as soon as it is safe to do so.

CONTINUED

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety 49

01/06/02 16:52:24 31S5A610_052

Page 53: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To get the best protection from theside airbags, front seat occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.

If you ever have a moderate tosevere side impact, the sensors willdetect rapid deceleration and signalthe control unit to instantly inflateeither the driver’s or the passenger’sside airbag.

Only one airbag will deploy during aside impact. If the impact is on thepassenger’s side, the passenger’sside airbag will deploy even if thereis no passenger.

Your car is equipped with sideairbags for the driver and a frontseat passenger. The airbags arestored in the outer edges of the frontseat-backs, and both are marked‘‘SIDE AIRBAG.’’

U.S. Owners:For additional information on howyour airbags work, see the booklettitled

that came with yourowner’s manual.

Canadian Owners:For additional information on howyour airbags work, ask your dealerfor a copy of the booklet titled

SRS: What You Need to KnowAbout Airbags

SRS:What You Need to Know About Airbags.

Only on U.S. models equipped with sideairbags.

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety

How Your Side Airbags Work

50

01/06/02 16:52:36 31S5A610_053

Page 54: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If the light comes on at any othertime, or does not come on at all, youshould have the system checked byyour dealer. For example:

If the SRS indicator light does notcome on after you turn the ignitionON (II).

If the light stays on after theengine starts.

If the light comes on or flashes onand off while you drive.

The SRS indicator lightalerts you to a potential

problem with your front airbags andautomatic seat belt tensioners.

On models with side airbags, thislight will also alert you to a potentialproblem with your side airbags orpassenger’s side airbag automaticcut-off system (see page ).

When you turn the ignition ON (II),this indicator will light briefly thengo out. This tells you that the systemis working properly.

If you see any of these indications,your front or side airbags may notdeploy, your passenger’s side airbagautomatic cut-off system may notwork properly, or your seat belttensioners may not work when youneed them. See your Honda dealeras soon as possible.

52

How the SRS Indicator LightWorks

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety 51

Ignoring the SRS indicator lightcan result in serious injury ordeath if the airbags, cut-offsystem, or tensioners do notwork properly.

Have your vehicle checked by adealer as soon as possible ifthe SRS light alerts you to apotential problem.

01/06/02 16:52:48 31S5A610_054

Page 55: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

A front seat passenger should notuse a cushion or other object as abackrest. It may prevent the cut-offsystem from working properly.

When you turn the ignition ON (II),the indicator should light briefly andgo out (see page ). If it doesn’tlight, stays on, or comes on whiledriving without a passenger in thefront seat, have the system checked.

If a small-statured adult leanssideways, or larger adult slouchesand leans sideways into thedeployment path of the side airbag,the system may also shut off the sideairbag.

If the side airbag cut-off indicatorlight comes on, you should have thepassenger sit upright. Once thepassenger is out of the deploymentpath of the side airbag, the systemwill turn the airbag back on and thelight will go out.

To reduce the risk of injury from aninflating side airbag, your car has anautomatic cut-off system for thepassenger’s side airbag.

Although Honda does not encouragechildren to ride in the front, thissystem is designed to shut off theside airbag if a child leans sidewaysand the child’s head is in the sideairbag deployment path.

If does not mean there is a problemwith your side airbags. It means thatthe side airbag cut-off system hasactivated to prevent the side airbagfrom deploying.

This light alerts you thatthe passenger’s side airbag

has been automatically shut off. 61

Only on U.S. models equipped with sideairbags

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety

How the Side Airbag Cut-offIndicator Light Works

52

01/06/02 16:52:58 31S5A610_055

Page 56: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Together, airbags andseat belts provide the bestprotection.

Tampering could causethe airbags to deploy, possiblycausing very serious injury.

See page for further informationand precautions relating to yourairbags.

If rain or spilled watersoaks into a seat-back, it canprevent the side airbag systemfrom working properly.

Improperlyreplacing or covering front seat-back covers can prevent your sideairbags from inflating during acollision.

Your front and side airbag systems(if equipped) are virtuallymaintenance-free, and there are noparts you can safely service.However, you must have your carserviced if:

Take your car to anauthorized Honda dealer as soonas possible. If you ignore thisindication, the airbags might notinflate when you need them.

Anyairbag that has deployed must bereplaced along with the controlunit, automatic seat belttensioners, and other related parts.Do not try to remove or replaceany airbag by yourself. This mustbe done by a Honda dealer or aknowledgeable body shop.

172

Airbag Service Additional Safety PrecautionsDo not attempt to deactivate yourairbags.

Do not tamper with airbagcomponents or wiring for anyreason.

Do not expose the front seat-backsto water.

Do not cover or replace front seat-back covers without consulting aHonda dealer.

The SRS indicator light alerts youto a problem.

Your airbags ever inflate.

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety 53

01/06/02 16:53:09 31S5A610_056

Page 57: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

High levels of carbon monoxide cancollect rapidly in enclosed areas,such as a garage. Do not run theengine with the garage door closed.Even with the door open, run theengine only long enough to move thevehicle out of the garage.

Your car’s exhaust contains carbonmonoxide gas. You should have noproblem with carbon monoxideentering the car in normal driving ifyou maintain your car properly.Have the exhaust system inspectedfor leaks whenever:

The car is raised for an oil change.You notice a change in the soundof the exhaust.The car was in an accident thatmay have damaged the underside.

If you must sit in your parked car,even in an unconfined area, with theengine running, adjust the heatingand cooling system as follows:

With the trunk lid open, air flow canpull exhaust gas into your car’sinterior and create a hazardouscondition. If you must drive with thetrunk lid open, open all the windowsand set the heating and coolingsystem as shown below.

Select the Fresh Air mode.Select the mode.Turn the fan on high speed.Set the temperature control to acomfortable setting.

1.2.3.4.

Carbon Monoxide Hazard

Driver and Passenger Safety54

Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.Breathing it can causeunconsciousness and even killyou.

Avoid any enclosed areas oractivities that expose you tocarbon monoxide.

01/06/02 16:53:18 31S5A610_057

Page 58: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

These labels are in the locationsshown. They warn you of potentialhazards that could cause seriousinjury. Read these labels carefully.

If a label comes off or becomes hardto read, contact your Honda dealerfor a replacement.

CONTINUED

U.S. models

Canadian models

U.S. models only

Safety Labels

Driver and Passenger Safety 55

RADIATOR CAP

SUN VISORDASHBOARD

01/06/02 16:53:38 31S5A610_058

Page 59: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

On models without side airbags

On models with side airbags

Safety Labels

Driver and Passenger Safety56

HOOD

01/06/02 16:53:47 31S5A610_059

Page 60: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This section gives information aboutthe controls and displays thatcontribute to the daily operation ofyour Honda. All the essentialcontrols are within easy reach.

...........................Control Locations . 58...............................Indicator Lights . 59

.............................................Gauges . 66...............................Speedometer . 66

.................................Tachometer . 66...............Odometer/Trip Meter . 66

..................................Fuel Gauge . 67...................Temperature Gauge . 68

Controls Near the Steering.......................................Wheel . 69

...................................Headlights . 70............Daytime Running Lights . 71

....Instrument Panel Brightness . 71................................Turn Signals . 72

.....................Windshield Wipers . 72..................Windshield Washers . 74

..........................Hazard Warning . 74.............Rear Window Defogger . 75

......Steering Wheel Adjustment . 76...............................Keys and Locks . 77

..............................................Keys . 77....................Immobilizer System . 78

............................Ignition Switch . 80..................................Door Locks . 81

......................Power Door Locks . 82...................Remote Transmitter . 83

..............Childproof Door Locks . 86...........................................Trunk . 86

........Emergency Trunk Opener . 87............................Seat Adjustments . 88

.............Front Seat Adjustments . 88Driver’s Seat Height

..............................Adjustment . 89................Driver’s Seat Armrest . 89

..........................Head Restraints . 90...........................Folding Rear Seat . 91

..............................Power Windows . 93.........................................Moonroof . 95

.............................................Mirrors . 96....Adjusting the Power Mirrors . 96

.................................Parking Brake . 97........................................Glove Box . 98

.............................Beverage Holder . 99.................Console Compartment . 100

........................................Coin Box . 101...............................Center Pocket . 101

.............Accessory Power Socket . 101...............................Interior Lights . 102..............................Ceiling Light . 102

...................................Spotlights . 103..........................Courtesy Light . 103

Instruments and Controls

Instruments and Controls 57

01/06/02 16:53:53 31S5A610_060

Page 61: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Control Locations

Instruments and Controls58

AAUUDDIIOO SSYYSSTTEEMM

DDIIGGIITTAALL CCLLOOCCKK

MMOOOONNRROOOOFF HHEEAATTIINNGG//CCOOOOLLIINNGG CCOONNTTRROOLLSS

FFUUEELL FFIILLLL DDOOOORR RREELLEEAASSEE

TTRRUUNNKK RREELLEEAASSEE

((PP.. 110066))

((PP.. 111144,, 112266,, 113388))

((PP.. 111199,, 113311,, 114433))

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLL

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLL

MMIIRRRROORRCCOONNTTRROOLLSS

PPOOWWEERR DDOOOORR LLOOCCKKSSWWIITTCCHH

PPOOWWEERR WWIINNDDOOWWSSWWIITTCCHHEESS

HHOOOODD RREELLEEAASSEEHHAANNDDLLEE

((PP.. 9966))((PP.. 9955))

((PP.. 8822))

((PP.. 115599))

((PP.. 9933))

((PP.. 116655))

((PP.. 8866)) ((PP.. 116666))

((PP.. 116600))

01/06/02 16:54:00 31S5A610_061

Page 62: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

**

**

The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text. CONTINUED

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls

EX and LX

59

LLOOWW OOIILL PPRREESSSSUURREEIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSUUPPPPLLEEMMEENNTTAALL RREESSTTRRAAIINNTT SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR TTRRUUNNKK--OOPPEENN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

MMAALLFFUUNNCCTTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLAAMMPP

LLOOWW FFUUEELL IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

((PP.. 6611))

((PP.. 6622))

((PP.. 6644))

((PP.. 6633))

((PP.. 6611))

((PP.. 6633))

((PP.. 6633))

((PP.. 6622))

((PP.. 6644))

((PP.. 6633))

((PP.. 6611))

AANNTTII--LLOOCCKK BBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

HHIIGGHH BBEEAAMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPAARRKKIINNGG BBRRAAKKEE AANNDDBBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLLIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

MMAAIINNTTEENNAANNCCEE RREEQQUUIIRREEDDIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSEEAATT BBEELLTTRREEMMIINNDDEERR LLIIGGHHTT

CCHHAARRGGIINNGG SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

IIMMMMOOBBIILLIIZZEERR SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

((PP.. 228811))

SSIIDDEE AAIIRRBBAAGG CCUUTT--OOFFFF IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

((PP.. 6622,, 227799))

((PP.. 6622,, 228800))

01/06/02 16:54:07 31S5A610_062

Page 63: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

**

The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls

DX

60

LLOOWW OOIILL PPRREESSSSUURREEIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSUUPPPPLLEEMMEENNTTAALL RREESSTTRRAAIINNTT SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR TTRRUUNNKK--OOPPEENN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

MMAALLFFUUNNCCTTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLAAMMPP

LLOOWW FFUUEELL IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

((PP.. 6611)) ((PP.. 6633))

((PP.. 6611))

((PP.. 6633))

((PP.. 6622))

((PP.. 6644))

((PP.. 6633))

((PP.. 6611))

((PP.. 6644))

PPAARRKKIINNGG BBRRAAKKEE AANNDDBBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

MMAAIINNTTEENNAANNCCEE RREEQQUUIIRREEDDIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSEEAATT BBEELLTTRREEMMIINNDDEERR LLIIGGHHTT

HHIIGGHH BBEEAAMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

CCHHAARRGGIINNGG SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

IIMMMMOOBBIILLIIZZEERR SSYYSSTTEEMMIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

((PP.. 228811))

SSIIDDEE AAIIRRBBAAGG CCUUTT--OOFFFF IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

((PP.. 6622,, 227799))

((PP.. 6622,, 228800))

01/06/02 16:54:15 31S5A610_063

Page 64: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The instrument panel has manyindicators to give you importantinformation about your car.

This indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). It is areminder to you and your passengersto protect yourselves by fasteningthe seat belts. A beeper also soundsif you have not fastened your seatbelt.

If you do not fasten your seat belt,the beeper will stop after a fewseconds but the light stays on untilyou do. Both the light and the beeperstay off if you fasten your seat beltbefore turning on the ignition.

This indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates that the passenger’s sideairbag has automatically shut off.For complete information, see page

.

This indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates a potential problem withyour front airbags or automatic seatbelt tensioners. On models equippedwith side airbags, this light will alsoalert you to a potential problem withyour side airbags or passenger’s sideairbag automatic cut-off system. Forcomplete information, see page .51

52

CONTINUED

Only on U.S. models equipped with sideairbags

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls

Seat Belt Reminder Light

Supplemental RestraintSystem Indicator

Side Airbag Cut-offIndicator

61

01/06/02 16:54:27 31S5A610_064

Page 65: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This light has two functions:This light normally comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II), and whenthe ignition switch is turned toSTART (III). If this light comes on atany other time, there is a problem inthe ABS. If this happens, take thecar to your dealer to have it checked.With the light on, your car still hasnormal braking ability but no anti-lock. For complete information, seepage .

If this light comes on when theengine is running, the battery is notbeing charged. For completeinformation, see page .

The engine can be severely damagedif this light flashes or stays on whenthe engine is running. For completeinformation, see page .

This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch ON (II). Itis a reminder to check the parkingbrake. Driving with the parkingbrake not fully released candamage the brakes and tires.

If the indicator remains lit afteryou have fully released theparking brake while the engine isrunning, or if it comes on whiledriving, it can indicate a problemin the brake system. For completeinformation, see page .

1.

2.

280

279

283

191

Only on models equipped with ABS (seepage )189

Parking Brakeand BrakeSystemIndicator

Anti-lock BrakeSystem (ABS)Indicator

Charging SystemIndicator

Low Oil PressureIndicator

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls62

U.S. Canada U.S. Canada

01/06/02 16:54:39 31S5A610_065

Page 66: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This light comes on with the highbeam headlights. See page forinformation on the headlightcontrols.

This lights when you set the cruisecontrol. See page for informationon operating the cruise control.

On Canadian models, this indicatorcomes on with reduced brightnesswhen the Daytime Running Lights(DRL) are on (see page ).

See page .

The left or right turn signal lightblinks when you signal a lane changeor turn. If the light does not blink orblinks rapidly, it usually means oneof the turn signal bulbs is burned out(see page ). Replace the bulb assoon as possible, since other driverscannot see that you are signalling.

This light comes on if the trunk lid isnot closed tightly.

This light comes on as a reminderthat you must refuel soon.

When you turn on the HazardWarning switch, both turn signallights blink. All turn signals on theoutside of the car should flash.

This light comes on when thewasher fluid level is low. Add washerfluid when you see this light come on(see page ).

70

71

281

248

159219

Only on models equipped with CruiseControl System

Canadian models only

High Beam Indicator

Cruise Control Indicator

Malfunction IndicatorLamp

Turn Signal andHazard WarningIndicators

Low Fuel Indicator

Washer Level Indicator

Trunk-open Indicator

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls 63

01/06/02 16:54:58 31S5A610_066

Page 67: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This indicator comes on for a fewseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch ON (II). It will then go off ifyou have inserted a properly-codedignition key. If it is not a properly-coded key, the indicator will blinkand the engine will not start (seepage ).

This indicator also blinks severaltimes when you turn the ignitionswitch from ON (II) to ACCESSORY(I) or LOCK (0).

Between 8,000 miles (12,800 km)and 10,000 miles (16,000 km) thisindicator will light for two secondswhen you first turn the ignitionswitch ON (II), and then flash forten seconds.

If you exceed 10,000 miles (16,000km) without having the scheduledmaintenance performed, thisindicator will remain on as a constantreminder.

Refer to the Maintenance Schedulesfor Normal and Severe DrivingConditions on pages .

For the first 8,000 miles (12,800 km)after the Maintenance RequiredIndicator is reset, it will come on fortwo seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II).

78

198 204

Indicator Lights

Immobilizer SystemIndicator

Maintenance RequiredIndicator

Instruments and Controls64

01/06/02 16:55:08 31S5A610_067

Page 68: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your dealer will reset this indicatorafter completing the scheduledmaintenance. If this maintenance isdone by someone other than yourHonda dealer, reset the indicator asfollows.

Turn off the engine.

Press and hold the select/resetbutton in the instrument panel,then turn the ignition switch ON(II).

Hold the button until the indicatorresets (approximately tenseconds).

1.

2.

3.

Indicator Lights

Instruments and Controls 65

01/06/02 16:55:16 31S5A610_068

Page 69: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This shows your speed in miles perhour (mph). The smaller innernumbers are the speed in kilometersper hour (km/h).

The tachometer shows the enginespeed in revolutions per minute(rpm). To protect the engine fromdamage, never drive with thetachometer needle in the red zone.

The odometer shows the total dis-tance your car has been driven. Itmeasures miles in U.S. models andkilometers in Canadian models.It is illegal under U.S. federal law andCanadian provincial regulations todisconnect, reset, or alter theodometer with the intent to changethe number of miles or kilometersindicated.

This shows your speed in kilometersper hour (km/h). The smaller innernumbers are the speed in miles perhour (mph).

The trip meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it.

U.S. ModelsCanadian Models

On LX and EX models

Speedometer

Tachometer

Odometer/Trip Meter

EX and LX

Gauges

Instruments and Controls66

FFUUEELL GGAAUUGGEE

TTAACCHHOOMMEETTEERR

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE GGAAUUGGEE

SSEELLEECCTT//RREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNOODDOOMMEETTEERR//TTRRIIPP MMEETTEERR

SSPPEEEEDDOOMMEETTEERR

01/06/02 16:55:30 31S5A610_069

Page 70: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This shows how much fuel you have.It is most accurate when the car is onlevel ground. It may show slightlymore or less than the actual amountwhen you are driving on curvy orhilly roads.

There are two trip meters: Trip Aand Trip B. The odometer and thetwo trip meters use the same display.Switch between these displays andthe odometer by pressing the Select/Reset button repeatedly. Each tripmeter works independently, so youcan keep track of two differentdistances.

To reset a trip meter, display it, andthen press and hold the Select/Resetbutton until the number resets to‘‘0.0’’.

The needle returns to the bottomafter you turn off the ignition. The

gauge shows the fuel level readingimmediately after you turn theignition switch back ON (II).

Gauges

Instruments and Controls

Fuel Gauge

DX

67

FFUUEELL GGAAUUGGEETTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREE GGAAUUGGEE

OODDOOMMEETTEERR//TTRRIIPP MMEETTEERR

SSPPEEEEDDOOMMEETTEERR

SSEELLEECCTT//RREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONN

Please ref uel early, as driving to thelast drop of f uel can result in damageto the engine and/or three way catalyticconverter.

01/06/02 16:55:40 31S5A610_070

Page 71: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This shows the temperature of theengine’s coolant. During normaloperation, the pointer should risefrom the bottom white mark to aboutthe middle of the gauge. In severedriving conditions, such as very hotweather or a long period of uphilldriving, the pointer may rise to theupper zone. If it reaches the red(Hot) mark, pull safely to the side ofthe road. Turn to page forinstructions and precautions onchecking the engine’s coolingsystem.

276

Gauges

Instruments and Controls

Temperature Gauge

68

01/06/02 16:55:45 31S5A610_071

Page 72: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

**

The two levers on the steeringcolumn contain controls for drivingfeatures you use most often. The leftlever controls the turn signals,headlights, and high beams. Theright lever controls the windshieldwashers and wipers.

The hazard warning lights switch ison the dashboard between thecenter air vents.

To use the horn, press the centerpad of the steering wheel.

The tilt adjustment lever on theunderside of the steering columnallows you to tilt the steering wheel.

The controls under the left air ventare for the moonroof, mirrors andcruise control.

The rear window defogger switch ison the heating and cooling controlpanel.

:

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls 69

HHAAZZAARRDD WWAARRNNIINNGGLLIIGGHHTTSS

MMOOOONNRROOOOFF

TTIILLTT AADDJJUUSSTTMMEENNTT

WWIINNDDSSHHIIEELLDDWWIIPPEERRSS//WWAASSHHEERRSS

MMIIRRRROORR CCOONNTTRROOLLSS

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWWDDEEFFOOGGGGEERR

HHEEAADDLLIIGGHHTTSS//TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALLSS

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLLSSWWIITTCCHHEESS

CCRRUUIISSEE CCOONNTTRROOLLMMAASSTTEERRSSWWIITTCCHH

HHOORRNN

01/06/02 16:55:56 31S5A610_072

Page 73: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The rotating switch on the left levercontrols the lights. Turning thisswitch to the ‘‘ ’’ position turnson the parking lights, taillights,instrument panel lights, side-markerlights, and rear license plate lights.Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’position turns on the headlights.

To change from low beams to highbeams, push the turn signal leverforward until you hear a click. Theblue high beam indicator will light(see page ). To return to lowbeams, pull the turn signal leverback.

If you leave the lights on with theignition switch in ACCESSORY (I)or LOCK (0), you will hear areminder tone when you open thedriver’s door.

To flash the high beams, pull theturn signal lever back lightly, thenrelease it. The high beams will comeon and go off. The high beams willstay on for as long as you hold thelever back, no matter what positionthe headlight switch is in.

63

Headlights

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls70

01/06/02 16:56:06 31S5A610_073

Page 74: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Canadian models onlyWith the headlight switch off, thehigh beam headlights come on withreduced brightness when you turnthe ignition switch to ON (II) andrelease the parking brake. Theyremain on until you turn the ignitionoff, even if you set the parking brake.

The headlights revert to normaloperation when you turn them onwith the switch.

Turn the knob on the left side of theinstrument panel to adjust thebrightness of the instrument panellights.

Instrument Panel BrightnessDaytime Running Lights

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls 71

01/06/02 16:56:15 31S5A610_074

Page 75: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Signal a turn or lane change with thislever. Push down on the lever tosignal a left turn, and up to signal aright turn. If you push it up or downall the way, the turn signal continuesto blink even when you release thelever. It shuts off automatically asyou complete the turn.

To signal a lane change, push lightlyon the turn signal lever in the properdirection and hold it. The lever willreturn to the center position as soonas you release it.

This lever controls the windshieldwipers and washers. It has fivepositions:

MIST: mistOFF: offINT: intermittentLO: low speedHI: high speed

To select a position, push the leverup or down.

Turn Signals Windshield Wipers

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls72

TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALL LLEEVVEERR

01/06/02 16:56:25 31S5A610_075

Page 76: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

In intermittent, the wipers operateevery few seconds. In low speed andhigh speed, the wipers run continu-ously.

In intermittent, you can vary howoften the wipers sweep thewindshield by turning the INT TIMEring on the right lever. In low speedand high speed, the wipers runcontinuously.

To operate the wipers in mist mode,push the control lever up from theOFF position. The wipers run at highspeed until you release the lever.This gives you a quick way to clearthe windshield.

On EX model in the U.S., and LXmodel in Canada

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls 73

IINNTT TTIIMMEE RRIINNGG

01/06/02 16:56:33 31S5A610_076

Page 77: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To clean the windshield, pull back onthe wiper control lever. The washersspray until you release the lever.

Push the button between the centervents to turn on the hazard warninglights (four-way flashers). Thiscauses all four outside turn signalsand both indicators in the instrumentpanel to flash. Use the hazardwarning lights if you need to park ina dangerous area near heavy traffic,or if your car is disabled.

The wipers run at low speed whileyou’re pulling the lever, thencomplete one more sweep of thewindshield after you release it.

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls

Windshield Washers Hazard Warning

74

01/06/02 16:56:42 31S5A610_077

Page 78: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The rear window defogger will clearfog, frost, and thin ice from thewindow. Push the defogger button toturn it on and off. The light in thebutton lights to show the defogger ison. If you do not turn it off, thedefogger will shut itself off afterabout 15 minutes. It also shuts offwhen you turn off the ignition. Youhave to turn it on again when yourestart the car.

Make sure the rear window is clearand you have good visibility beforestarting to drive.

The defogger and antenna wires onthe inside of the rear window can beaccidentally damaged. Whencleaning the glass, always wipe sideto side.

Rear Window Defogger

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls 75

01/06/02 16:56:49 31S5A610_078

Page 79: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Push the lever up to lock thesteering wheel in that position.

Make sure you have securelylocked the steering wheel in placeby trying to move it up and down.

Move the steering wheel to thedesired position, making sure thewheel points toward your chest,not toward your face. Make sureyou can see the instrument panelgauges and the indicator lights.

Push the lever under the steeringcolumn all the way down.

To adjust the steering wheel upwardor downward:

Make any steering wheel adjustmentbefore you start driving.

1.

4.

3.

2.

See page for important safetyinformation about how to properlyposition the steering wheel.

18Steering Wheel Adjustment

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

Instruments and Controls76

Adjusting the steering wheelposition while driving maycause you to lose control of thecar and be seriously injured in acrash.

Adjust the steering wheel onlywhen the car is stopped.

01/06/02 16:57:00 31S5A610_079

Page 80: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Your car comes with two masterkeys and a valet key.The master key fits all the locks onyour car:• Ignition• Doors• Trunk• Trunk release handle• Rear seat trunk access

The valet key works only in theignition and the door locks. You cankeep the trunk, trunk release handleand rear seat trunk access lockedwhen you leave your car and thevalet key at a parking facility. (SeeTrunk, page .)

You should have received a keynumber plate with your set of keys.You will need this key number if youever have to get a lost key replaced.Keep the plate stored in a safe place.When replacing keys, use onlyHonda-approved key blanks.

These keys contain electroniccircuits that are activated by theImmobilizer System. They will notwork to start the engine if thecircuits are damaged.

Protect the keys from directsunlight, high temperature, andhigh humidity.

The keys do not contain batteries.Do not try to take them apart.

Keep the keys away from liquids.If they get wet, dry them immedi-ately with a soft cloth.

Do not drop the keys or set heavyobjects on them.

86

Instruments and Controls

Keys

Keys and Locks

77

KKEEYYNNUUMMBBEERRPPLLAATTEE

MMAASSTTEERRKKEEYYSS((BBllaacckk))

VVAALLEETTKKEEYY((GGrraayy))

01/06/02 16:57:15 31S5A610_080

Page 81: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Some models also come with tworemote transmitters; see page foran explanation of their operation.

The Immobilizer System protectsyour car from theft. A properly-coded master or valet key must beused in the ignition switch for theengine to start. If an improperly-coded key (or other device) is used,the engine’s fuel system is disabled.

When you turn the ignition switch toON (II), the Immobilizer Systemindicator should come on for a fewseconds, then go out. If the indicatorstarts to blink, it means the systemdoes not recognize the coding of thekey. Turn the ignition switch toLOCK (0), remove the key, reinsertit, and turn the switch to ON (II)again.

The system may not recognize yourkey’s coding if another immobilizerkey or other metal object is near theignition switch when you insert thekey. To make sure the systemrecognizes the key code:

Do not keep other immobilizerkeys on the same key ring.

Use a plastic or leather key fob,not metal.

Keep other keys away from yourcar’s key and the ignition switchwhile trying to start the engine.

If the system repeatedly does notrecognize the coding of your key,contact your Honda dealer.

85

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Remote Transmitter Immobilizer System

78

01/06/02 16:57:25 31S5A610_081

Page 82: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This indicator will also blink severaltimes when you turn the ignitionswitch from ON (II) to ACCESSORY(I) or LOCK (0).

Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it. Electricalproblems could result that may makeyour car undriveable.

If you have lost your key and youcannot start the engine, contact yourHonda dealer.

As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.

Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.

This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls 79

01/06/02 16:57:33 31S5A610_082

Page 83: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- You can insert orremove the key only in this position.To switch from ACCESSORY toLOCK, you must push the key inslightly as you turn it. If your car hasan automatic transmission, the shiftlever must also be in Park. The anti-theft lock will lock the steeringcolumn when you remove the key.

If the front wheels are turned, theanti-theft lock may sometimes makeit difficult to turn the key fromLOCK to ACCESSORY. Firmly turnthe steering wheel to the left or tothe right as you turn the key.

The ignition switch is on the rightside of the steering column. It hasfour positions:• LOCK (0)• ACCESSORY (I)• ON (II)• START (III)

Instruments and Controls

Keys and Locks

LOCK (0)Ignition Switch

80

Removing the key from theignition switch while drivinglocks the steering. This cancause you to lose control.

Remove the key from theignition switch only whenparked.

01/06/02 16:57:41 31S5A610_083

Page 84: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

-In this position,you can operate the audio systemand the accessory power socket.

This is the normal keyposition when driving. All featuresand accessories on the car are usable.Several of the lights on the instru-ment panel come on as a test whenyou turn the ignition switch fromACCESSORY to ON.

Each door has a lock tab on the top.Push the tab down to lock the doorand pull it up to unlock.

To lock any passenger’s door whengetting out of the car, push the locktab down and close the door. To lockthe driver’s door, pull the outsidedoor handle and push the lock tabdown. Release the handle, then closethe door.

Use this positiononly to start the engine. The switchreturns to ON (II) when you let go ofthe key.

The engine will not start if theImmobilizer System does notrecognize the key’s coding (see page

).

You will hear a reminder beeper ifyou leave the key in the ignitionswitch in the LOCK (0) orACCESSORY (I) position and openthe driver’s door. Remove the key toturn off the beeper.

78

CONTINUED

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

ACCESSORY (I)

ON (II)

Door LocksSTART (III)

81

01/06/02 16:57:53 31S5A610_084

Page 85: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The master door lock switch allowscontrol of all door locks from thedriver’s door. Push the switch downto lock all doors, and up to unlockthem.

The front doors can be locked andunlocked from the outside with thekey.

All doors lock when you push downthe lock tab on the driver’s door, orlock the driver’s door from theoutside with the key. Only the driver’sdoor unlocks when you use the keyor lock tab. To unlock the passen-gers’ doors, use the master door lockswitch or the lock tab on each door.

Standard on LX and EX models in theU.S., and LX model in CanadaOptional on DX model in Canada

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Power Door Locks

82

MMAASSTTEERR DDOOOORR LLOOCCKK SSWWIITTCCHH

01/06/02 16:58:02 31S5A610_085

Page 86: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

You can lock and unlock your carwith the remote transmitter. Whenyou push the LOCK button, all doorslock. The parking lights, side markerlights, and taillights flash once.

When you push the LOCK button asecond time within 5 seconds afteryou have locked the doors, the hornwill sound once to verify that thedoors are locked.

When you push the UNLOCK buttononce, only the driver’s door unlocks.The remaining doors unlock whenyou push the button a second time.The parking lights, side markerlights, and taillights flash twice.

The ceiling light (if the ceiling lightswitch is in the center position) willcome on when you press theUNLOCK button. If you do not openany of the doors, the light will go outin about 30 seconds and the doorswill automatically relock. If yourelock the doors with the remotetransmitter before 30 seconds haveelapsed, the light will go offimmediately.

You cannot lock or unlock the doorswith the remote transmitter if anydoor is not fully closed or the key isin the ignition switch.

Standard on EX model in the U.S., andLX and DX-GOP models in CanadaOptional on LX model in the U.S.

Remote Transmitter

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls 83

LLEEDD

UUNNLLOOCCKKBBUUTTTTOONN

LLOOCCKKBBUUTTTTOONN

PPAANNIICCBBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 16:58:12 31S5A610_086

Page 87: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To replace the battery, remove theround cover on the back of the trans-mitter by turning it counterclockwisewith a coin.

Remove the old battery and note thepolarity. Make sure the polarity ofthe new battery is the same ( sidefacing up), then insert it in thetransmitter.

When the remote transmitter’sbattery begins to get weak, it maytake several pushes on the button tolock or unlock the doors, and theLED will get dim. Replace thebattery as soon as possible.

Battery type: CR2025

To cancel Panic mode before 30seconds, press any button on theremote transmitter. You can alsoturn the ignition switch to ON (II).

Panic mode will not activate if theignition switch is in the ON (II)position.

Panic mode allows you to remotelyactivate your car’s horn and exteriorlights to attract attention. Whenactivated, the horn will sound, andthe exterior lights will flash, forabout 30 seconds. To activate panicmode, press and hold the PANICbutton for about one second.

Instruments and Controls

Keys and Locks

Replacing the BatteryPanic Mode

84

OOppeenn

CClloossee

RROOUUNNDDCCOOVVEERR

CCUUSSHHIIOONNRRIINNGG

BBAATTTTEERRYY

01/06/02 16:58:24 31S5A610_087

Page 88: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

▽◎

As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.

Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.

This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.

Avoid severe shock to the trans-mitter, such as dropping or throwingit. Also, protect it from extreme hotor cold temperatures.

Clean the transmitter case with asoft cloth. Do not use strongcleaners or solvents that could harmthe case. Immersing the transmitterin any liquid will harm the trans-mitter and cause it to not functionproperly.

If you lose a transmitter, you willneed to have the replacementprogrammed to your car’s system byyour Honda dealer. Any othertransmitters you have will also needto be reprogrammed.

Reinstall the cushion ring. Align themark on the cover with themark on the transmitter,

then set the cover in place and turn itclockwise.

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Transmitter Care

85

01/06/02 16:58:35 31S5A610_088

Page 89: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To close the trunk, press down onthe trunk lid.

See page for cargo loading andweight limit information. Keep thetrunk lid closed at all times whiledriving to avoid damaging the lid,and to prevent exhaust gas fromgetting into the interior. See

on page .

You can open the trunk in two ways:

Pull the trunk release handle tothe left of the driver’s seat.

Use the master key to open thetrunk lock. The valet key does notwork in this lock.

The childproof door locks aredesigned to prevent children seatedin the rear from accidentally openingthe rear doors. Each rear door has alock lever near the edge. With thelever in the LOCK position, the doorcannot be opened from the insideregardless of the position of the locktab. To open the door, pull the locktab up and use the outside doorhandle.

54

173

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Trunk

CarbonMonoxide Hazard

Childproof Door Locks

86

TTRRUUNNKK RREELLEEAASSEE HHAANNDDLLEE MMAASSTTEERR KKEEYY

LLEEVVEERR

PPuullll

01/06/02 16:58:47 31S5A610_089

Page 90: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To protect items in the trunk whenyou need to give the key to someoneelse, lock the trunk release handlewith the master key and give theother person the valet key.

As a safety feature, your car has arelease lever on the trunk latch sothe trunk can be opened from theinside.

Parents should decide if theirchildren should be shown how to usethis feature.

For more information about childsafety, see page .

To open the trunk, push the releaselever to the left.

26

U.S. models only

Keys and Locks

Instruments and Controls

Emergency Trunk Opener

87

MMAASSTTEERR KKEEYY

01/06/02 16:58:57 31S5A610_090

Page 91: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

-See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position seats and seat-backs.

13 15

Make all seat adjustments beforeyou start driving.

To change the angle of the seat-back,pull up on the lever on the outside ofthe seat bottom. Move the seat-backto the desired position and releasethe lever. Let the seat-back latch inthe new position.

To adjust the seat forward andbackward, pull up on the bar underthe seat cushion’s front edge. Movethe seat to the desired position andrelease the bar. Try to move the seatto make sure it is locked in position.

Front Seat Adjustments

Seat Adjustments

Instruments and Controls88

01/06/02 16:59:07 31S5A610_091

Page 92: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To adjust the height of the driver’sseat, turn the dial on the outside ofthe seat bottom.

To use the driver’s seat armrest,pivot it down.

On EX model in the U.S., and LX modelin Canada

On LX and EX models in the U.S., andLX model in Canada

Driver’s Seat Height Adjustment Driver’s Seat Armrest

Seat Adjustments

Instruments and Controls 89

01/06/02 16:59:15 31S5A610_092

Page 93: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To remove a head restraint forcleaning or repair, pull it up as far asit will go. Push the release buttonand pull the restraint out of the seat-back.

The front head restraints adjust forheight. You need both hands toadjust the restraint. Do not attemptto adjust it while driving. To raise it,pull upward. To lower the restraint,push the release button sidewaysand push the restraint down.

The front head restraints helpprotect you and your passenger fromwhiplash and other injuries. They aremost effective when you adjust themso the back of the occupant’s headrests against the center of therestraint. A taller person shouldadjust the restraint as high aspossible.

See page for important safetyinformation and a warning about how toproperly position the head restraints.

16Head Restraints

Seat Adjustments

Instruments and Controls90

RREELLEEAASSEE BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 16:59:23 31S5A610_093

Page 94: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The back of the rear seat folds downto give you direct access to the trunk.Each side folds down separately.With only half the seat folded, youcan still carry a passenger in theback seat. The seat-back can bereleased from inside the car or insidethe trunk.

When storing cargo, you can movethe rear center shoulder belt out ofthe way by removing the belt fromthe guide.

To fold down either side of the seat-back from inside the car, insert themaster key in the lock on the rearshelf. To fold down the driver’s side,turn the key clockwise, pull down thetop of the seat-back, then release thekey. To fold down the passenger’sside, turn the key counterclockwiseand perform the same procedure.

CONTINUED

Folding Rear Seat

Instruments and Controls 91

MMAASSTTEERR KKEEYY

01/06/02 16:59:32 31S5A610_094

Page 95: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To release the seat-back from insidethe trunk, pull the release under thetrunk panel. Push the seat-backdown, then let go of the release.

To lock the seat-back upright, push itfirmly against the trunk panel. Makesure it is latched in place by pullingon the top of the seat.

Make sure all rear shoulder belts arepositioned in front of the rear seat-back whenever the seat-back is in itsupright position.

Do not put any heavy items on theseat-back when it is folded.

Make sure all items in the trunk, oritems extending through the openinginto the back seat, are secured.Loose items can fly forward andcause injury if you have to brakehard. See on page

.

Never drive with the seat-backfolded down and the trunk lid open.See onpage .54

173

Folding Rear Seat

Instruments and Controls

Carrying Cargo

Carbon Monoxide Hazard

92

RREELLEEAASSEE

01/06/02 16:59:41 31S5A610_095

Page 96: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Your car’s windows are electrically-powered. Turn the ignition switch toON (II) to raise or lower any window.

Each door has a switch that controlsits window. To open the window,push the switch down and hold it.Release the switch when you wantthe window to stop. Close thewindow by pulling back on theswitch and holding it.

The driver’s door armrest has amaster power window control panel.To open any of the passengers’ win-dows, push down on the appropriateswitch and hold it until the windowreaches the desired position. Toclose the window, pull back on thewindow switch. Release the switchwhen the window gets to the positionyou want.

On LX and EX models in the U.S., andLX model in Canada

Instruments and Controls

Power Windows

93

DDRRIIVVEERR’’SS WWIINNDDOOWW SSWWIITTCCHH

MMAAIINN SSWWIITTCCHH

Closing a power window onsomeone’s hands or fingers cancause serious injury.

Make sure your passengers areaway from the windows beforeclosing them.

01/06/02 16:59:50 31S5A610_096

Page 97: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The master control panel also con-tains these extra features:

To open the driver’swindow fully, push the windowswitch firmly down and release it.The window automatically goes allthe way down. To stop the windowfrom going all the way down, pullback on the window switch briefly.

To open the driver’s window onlypartially, push the window switchdown lightly and hold it. The windowwill stop as soon as you release theswitch.

The AUTO function only works tolower the driver’s window. To raisethe window, you must pull back onthe window switch and hold it untilthe window reaches the desiredposition.

The light inside the AUTO switchcomes on when you turn the ignition

switch to ON (II).

The MAIN switch controls power tothe passengers’ windows. When youpush in the MAIN switch, thepassengers’ windows cannot beraised or lowered. The MAIN switchdoes not affect the driver’s window.To cancel this feature, push on theswitch again to get it to pop out.Keep the MAIN switch pushed inwhen you have children in the car sothey do not injure themselves byoperating the windowsunintentionally.

AUTO

Instruments and Controls

Power Windows

94

01/06/02 16:59:57 31S5A610_097

Page 98: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The moonroof has two positions: itcan be tilted up in the back forventilation, or it can be slid back intothe roof. Use the switch under theleft dashboard vent to operate themoonroof. The ignition switch mustbe ON (II).

To tilt up the back of the moonroof,press and hold the center button( ). To close the moonroof,press and hold the top of the switch( ). To open the moonroof,press and hold the bottom of theswitch ( ). Release the switchwhen the moonroof gets to thedesired position. Make sureeveryone’s hands are away from themoonroof before opening or closingit.

On the U.S. EX model

Instruments and Controls

Moonroof

95

Opening or closing themoonroof on someone’s handsor fingers can cause seriousinjury.

Make sure all hands and fingersare clear of the moonroofbefore opening or closing it.

If you try to open the moonroof inbelow-f reezing temperatures, or whenit is covered with snow or ice, you candamage the moonroof panel or motor.

01/06/02 17:00:05 31S5A610_098

Page 99: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Push the appropriate edge of theadjustment switch to move themirror right, left, up, or down.

When you finish, move theselector switch to the center (off)position. This turns off theadjustment switch so you can’tmove a mirror out of position byaccidentally bumping the switch.

Adjust the outside mirrors with theadjustment switch on the left side ofthe dashboard:

Turn the ignition switch ON (II).

Move the selector switch to L(driver’s side) or R (passenger’sside).

Keep the inside and outside mirrorsclean and adjusted for best visibility.Be sure to adjust the mirrors beforeyou start driving.

The inside mirror has day and nightpositions. The night position reducesglare from headlights behind you.Flip the tab on the bottom edge ofthe mirror to select the day or nightposition.

3.

4.

1.

2.

On LX and EX models in the U.S., andLX model in Canada

Instruments and Controls

Mirrors

Adjusting the Power Mirrors

96

SSEELLEECCTTOORR SSWWIITTCCHHTTAABB AADDJJUUSSTTMMEENNTT SSWWIITTCCHH

01/06/02 17:00:18 31S5A610_099

Page 100: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To apply the parking brake, pull thelever up fully. To release it, pull upslightly, push the button, and lowerthe lever. The parking brake light onthe instrument panel should go outwhen the parking brake is fullyreleased (see page ).

The outside mirrors are heated to re-move fog and frost. With the ignitionswitch ON (II), turn on the heatersby pressing the button. The light inthe button comes on as a reminder.Press the button again to turn theheaters off.

62

On Canadian LX model

Instruments and Controls

Mirrors, Parking Brake

Parking Brake

97

PPAARRKKIINNGG BBRRAAKKEE LLEEVVEERR

Driving the car with the parking brakeapplied can damage the rear brakesand axles.

01/06/02 17:00:27 31S5A610_100

Page 101: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Open the glove box by squeezing thehandle. Close it with a firm push.

Instruments and Controls

Glove Box

98

An open glove box can causeserious injury to your passengerin a crash, even if thepassenger is wearing the seatbelt.

Always keep the glove boxclosed while driving.

01/06/02 17:00:33 31S5A610_101

Page 102: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To open the beverage holder, pushon the top. The beverageholder lid is spring-loaded and willswing open. To close it, push it downuntil it latches.

The lidless beverage holder islocated at the front of the centerconsole.

Be careful when you are using thebeverage holder. A spilled liquid thatis very hot can scald you or yourpassengers. Spilled liquids can alsodamage the upholstery, carpeting,and electrical components in theinterior.

CONTINUED

On LX and EX models in the U.S. On DX model in the U.S., and DXand LX models in Canada

Beverage Holder

Instruments and Controls 99

PPuusshh

01/06/02 17:00:41 31S5A610_102

Page 103: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

A beverage holder for rear seatpassengers is in the back of theconsole. To use it, pivot the lid down.

Squeeze the handle and slide theconsole compartment lid backwardto access the compartment.

On EX model in the U.S. On LX and EX models in the U.S., andLX model in Canada

Console Compartment

Instruments and Controls

Beverage Holder, Console Compartment

100

HHAANNDDLLEE

01/06/02 17:00:50 31S5A610_103

Page 104: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The coin box is located under the airvent. To open the coin box, pull thebottom edge. Close it with a firmpush.

It will not power an automotive typecigarette lighter element.

The center pocket is located underthe audio system. To open the lid,pull it down. Close it with a firm push.

To use the accessory power socket,pull up the cover.

This socket is intended to supplypower for 12 volt DC accessoriesthat are rated 120 watts or less (10amps). To power an accessory, theignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II).

On LX and EX models in the U.S. andLX model in Canada

Coin Box Center Pocket Accessory Power Socket

Coin Box, Center Pocket, Accessory Power Socket

Instruments and Controls 101

01/06/02 17:01:00 31S5A610_104

Page 105: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The ceiling light has a three-positionswitch. In the OFF position, the lightdoes not come on. In the centerposition, the ceiling light comes onwhen you open any door. In the ONposition, the ceiling light stays oncontinuously.

The ceiling light (with the switch inthe center position) comes on whenyou remove the key from the ignitionswitch. If you do not open a door, thelight stays on, then fades out inabout 10 seconds.

Your car also has a front ceiling lightbetween the sun visors.

The ceiling light (with the switch inthe center position) also comes onwhen you unlock the door with thekey or the remote transmitter (seepage ).83

On EX model in the U.S.

Ceiling Light

Interior Lights

Instruments and Controls102

EEXX

FFRROONNTT

01/06/02 17:01:10 31S5A610_105

Page 106: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your car also has a courtesy light inthe ignition switch. This light comeson when you open the driver’s door.It remains on for several secondsafter the door is closed.

Turn on the spotlight by pushing thelens. Push the lens again to turn itoff. You can use the spotlights at alltimes.

The front ceiling light contains twospotlights as well as a main light.Turn on the spotlight by pushing thebutton next to each light. Push thebutton again to turn it off. You canuse the spotlights at all times.

On EX model in the U.S. On LX model in the U.S. and Canada On EX model in the U.S.

Spotlights Courtesy Light

Interior Lights

Instruments and Controls 103

EEXX LLXX

01/06/02 17:01:20 31S5A610_106

Page 107: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

104

01/06/02 17:01:23 31S5A610_107

Page 108: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The heating and air conditioningsystems in your Honda provide acomfortable driving environment inall weather conditions.

The standard audio system hasmany features. This section de-scribes those features and how touse them. (If you selected anoptional audio system, refer to theoperating instructions that camewith it.)

.....................Heating and Cooling . 106.........What Each Control Does . 106

............How to Use the System . 108..........To Turn Everything Off . 113

Audio System (U.S. and........................Canadian DX) . 114

.................Operating the Radio . 114

.................Adjusting the Sound . 118............Audio System Lighting . 119

..............................Digital Clock . 119Operating the Optional Cassette

.....................................Player . 120............Tape Search Functions . 121

Operating the Optional.............CD Player/Changer . 123

...............Audio System (U.S. LX) . 126.................Operating the Radio . 126.................Adjusting the Sound . 130

............Audio System Lighting . 131..............................Digital Clock . 131

Operating the Cassette.....................................Player . 132

............Tape Search Functions . 133Operating the Optional

.............CD Player/Changer . 135

Audio System (U.S. EX and.....Canadian LX and DX-GOP) . 138

.................Operating the Radio . 138

.................Adjusting the Sound . 142............Audio System Lighting . 143

..............................Digital Clock . 143....................Radio Frequencies . 144

........................Radio Reception . 145.........Operating the CD Player . 147

.....Operating the CD Changer . 149.......Protecting Compact Discs . 150

....CD Player Error Indications . 151CD Changer Error

.............................Indications . 152Operating the Cassette

.....................................Player . 153............Tape Search Functions . 154

Caring for the Cassette.....................................Player . 156

............................Theft Protection . 157...............................Cruise Control . 159

Your Honda has an anti-theft audiosystem that requires a code numberto enable it.

Air conditioning is standard on LXand EX models in the U.S., and LXand DX-GOP models in Canada. It isoptional on other models.

On the U.S. EX model, and Canadian LXand DX-GOP models

Comfort and Convenience Features

Comfort and Convenience Features 105

01/06/02 17:01:31 31S5A610_108

Page 109: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Proper use of the Heating andCooling system can make theinterior dry and comfortable, andkeep the windows clear for bestvisibility.

If your car does not have airconditioning, it can be installed atany time. Your dealer can install agenuine Honda air conditioningsystem that meets Honda’s highquality standards and is designed toexactly fit your car. Please contactyour dealer for more information.

Turning this dial clockwise increasesthe fan’s speed, which increases airflow.

This button controls the source ofthe air going into the system. Whenthe indicator in this button is lit, airfrom the car’s interior is sentthrough the system again (Recircula-tion mode). When the indicator is off,air is brought in from outside the car(Fresh Air mode).

Turning this dial clockwise increasesthe temperature of the air flow.

This button turns the air condi-tioning ON and OFF. The indicatorin the button lights when the A/C ison.

This button turns the rear windowdefogger on and off (see page ).75

Standard for LX and EX models inthe U.S., and DX-GOP and LX models inCanadaOptional for other models

Comfort and Convenience Features

Heating and Cooling

Recirculation Button

What Each Control Does

Fan Control Dial

Temperature Control Dial

Air Conditioning (A/C) Button

Rear Window Defogger Button

106

AAIIRR CCOONNDDIITTIIOONNIINNGGBBUUTTTTOONN

MMOODDEE CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWWDDEEFFOOGGGGEERRBBUUTTTTOONN

FFAANN CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREECCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

01/06/02 17:01:46 31S5A610_109

Page 110: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Air flows from the floorvents.

Air flow is divided betweenthe vents in the dashboard and thefloor vents.

Air flows from the centerand corner vents in the dashboard.

Use the MODE control dial to selectthe vents the air flows from. Someair will flow from the dashboardvents in all modes.

When you select or ,the system automatically switches toFresh Air mode and turns on theA/C.

Air flows from the defrostervents at the base of the windshield.

When you select , the systemautomatically switches to Fresh Airmode.

Air flow is divided betweenthe floor vents and the defrostervents at the base of the windshield.

Heating and Cooling

Comfort and Convenience Features

Mode Control Dial

107

01/06/02 17:01:57 31S5A610_110

Page 111: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This section covers how to set up thesystem controls for ventilation,heating, cooling, dehumidifying, anddefrosting.

The engine must be running for theheater and air conditioning togenerate hot and cold air. The heateruses engine coolant to warm the air.If the engine is cold, it will be severalminutes before you feel warm aircoming from the system.

The air conditioning does not rely onengine temperature.

The vents in the corners of thedashboard can be opened and closedwith the dials underneath them.

The direction of air flow from thevents in the center and each side ofthe dashboard is adjustable.

To adjust the air flow from each vent,move the vent up-and-down andmove the tab side-to-side.

Heating and Cooling

Comfort and Convenience Features

Vent Controls How to Use the System

108

SSIIDDEE VVEENNTT

OOppeenn CClloossee

TTAABB

CCEENNTTEERR VVEENNTTSS

01/06/02 17:02:09 31S5A610_111

Page 112: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The outside air intakes for theheating and cooling system are atthe base of the windshield. Keepthese clear of leaves and otherdebris.

The flow-through ventilation systemdraws in outside air, circulates itthrough the interior, then exhausts itthrough vents near the rear window.

It is best to leave the system in FreshAir mode under almost all conditions.Keeping the system in Recirculationmode, particularly with the A/C off,can cause the windows to fog up.Switch to Recirculation mode whenyou are driving through smoky ordusty conditions, then switch back toFresh Air mode when the conditionclears.

Turn the temperature control dialall the way to the left.Make sure the A/C is off.Select and Fresh Air mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.

1.

2.3.

CONTINUED

Heating and Cooling

Comfort and Convenience Features

Ventilation

109

AAIIRR CCOONNDDIITTIIOONNIINNGGBBUUTTTTOONN

MMOODDEE CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREECCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

FFAANN CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWWDDEEFFOOGGGGEERRBBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:02:18 31S5A610_112

Page 113: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When the interior has cooled downto a more comfortable temperature,close the windows and set thecontrols as described for normalcooling.

Air conditioning places an extra loadon the engine. Watch the enginecoolant temperature gauge (see page

) when driving in stop-and-gotraffic or climbing a long, steep hill.If it moves near the red zone, turnoff the A/C until the gauge readsnormally.

If the interior is very warm frombeing parked in the sun, you can coolit down more rapidly by setting upthe controls this way:

Turn on the A/C by pressing thebutton. The light in the buttoncomes on when a fan speed isselected.Make sure the temperaturecontrol dial is all the way to the left.Select .If the outside air is humid, selectRecirculation mode. If the outsideair is dry, select Fresh Air mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.

Start the engine.Turn on the A/C by pressing thebutton. Make sure the tempera-ture control dial is turned all theway to the left.Set the fan to maximum speed.Open the windows partially. Select

and Fresh Air mode.

1.2.

3.4.

1.

2.

3.4.

5.

68

Comfort and Convenience Features

Heating and Cooling

To Cool with A/C

110

AAIIRR CCOONNDDIITTIIOONNIINNGGBBUUTTTTOONN

MMOODDEE CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREECCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

FFAANN CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWWDDEEFFOOGGGGEERRBBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:02:28 31S5A610_113

Page 114: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To warm the interior:Air conditioning, as it cools, removesmoisture from the air. When used incombination with the heater, itmakes the interior warm and dry.

To remove fog from the inside of thewindows:

This setting is suitable for all drivingconditions whenever the outsidetemperature is above 32°F (0°C).

Switch the fan on.Turn on the air conditioning.Select and Fresh Air mode.Adjust the temperature controldial so the mixture of heated andcooled air feels comfortable.

Switch the fan on.Select .When you select , thesystem automatically switches toFresh Air mode and turns on theA/C.Adjust the temperature controldial so the air flow from thedefroster vents feels warm.Turn on the rear window defoggerto help clear the rear window.When you switch to another modefrom , the A/C stays on.Press the A/C button to turn it off.

Start the engine.Select .When you select ,thesystem automatically switches toFresh Air mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.Adjust the warmth of the air withthe temperature control dial.

1.2.3.4.

1.2.

3.

4.

1.2.

3.4.

CONTINUED

Heating and Cooling

Comfort and Convenience Features

To Heat To Heat and Dehumidify with AirConditioning

To Defog and Defrost

111

01/06/02 17:02:40 31S5A610_114

Page 115: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Start the engine.Select .When you select , thesystem automatically switches toFresh Air mode and turns on theA/C.Switch the fan and temperaturecontrols to maximum.

To rapidly remove exterior frost orice from the windshield (on very colddays), first select the Recirculationmode. Once the windshield is clear,select the Fresh Air mode to avoidfogging the windows.

To remove exterior frost or ice fromthe windshield and side windowsafter the car has been sitting out incold weather:

1.2.

3.

Comfort and Convenience Features

Heating and Cooling

112

MMOODDEE CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

TTEEMMPPEERRAATTUURREECCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

RREECCIIRRCCUULLAATTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

AAIIRR CCOONNDDIITTIIOONNIINNGG BBUUTTTTOONN

FFAANN CCOONNTTRROOLL DDIIAALL

RREEAARR WWIINNDDOOWWDDEEFFOOGGGGEERR BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:02:47 31S5A610_115

Page 116: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

For safety, make sure you have aclear view through all the windowsbefore driving away.

You should shut the systemcompletely off only for the first fewminutes of driving in cold weather,until the engine coolant warms upenough to operate the heater. Keepthe fan on at all other times so staleair does not build up in the interior.

To shut off the system temporarily,turn the fan speed and temperaturecontrol dials all the way to the left.

These settings direct all the air flowto the defroster vents at the base ofthe windshield and the side windowdefroster vents. The air flow will getwarmer and clear the windows fasteras the engine warms up. You canclose the side vents with the dialunderneath each vent. This will sendmore warm air to the windshielddefroster vents.

Heating and Cooling

Comfort and Convenience Features

To Turn Everything Off

113

01/06/02 17:02:55 31S5A610_116

Page 117: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your Honda’s audio system providesclear reception on both AM and FMbands, while the preset buttons allowyou to easily select your favoritestations.

The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to is displayed.To change bands, press the AM/FMbutton. On the FM band, ST will bedisplayed if the station is broadcast-ing in stereo. Stereo reproduction onAM is not available.

The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) tooperate the audio system. Turn thesystem on by pushing the PWR/VOL knob or the AM/FM button.Adjust the volume by turning thePWR/VOL knob.

For DX model in the U.S. and Canada

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

AM/FM Stereo Audio System

Operating the Radio

114

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

AAUUTTOO SSEELLEECCTT BBUUTTTTOONN

SSCCAANN BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB SSEEEEKK BBAARR TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

SSCCAANN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSTTEERREEOO IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:03:05 31S5A610_117

Page 118: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- -

CONTINUED

You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, AUTOSELECT, and the Preset buttons.

Use the TUNE knob totune the radio to a desired frequency.Turn the TUNE knob to the right totune to a higher frequency, or to theleft to tune to a lower frequency.Turn the knob right or left until thedisplay reaches the desiredfrequency.

The SEEK functionsearches the band for a station witha strong signal. To activate it, pressthe SEEK bar on either the or

side, then release it.Depending on which side you press,the system scans upward or down-ward from the current frequency. Itstops when it finds a station with astrong signal.

The SCAN functionsamples all the stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. When the system isin the SCAN mode, SCAN shows inthe display. The system will scan upthe band for a station with a strongsignal. When it finds one, it will stopand play that station forapproximately five seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and playthat for five seconds. When it plays astation that you want to continuelistening to, press the SCAN buttonagain.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

TUNE

SEEK SCAN

115

01/06/02 17:03:12 31S5A610_118

Page 119: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- You can store thefrequencies of your favorite radiostations in the six preset buttons.Each button will store one frequencyon the AM band, and twofrequencies on the FM band.

To store a frequency:

Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each Presetbutton.

Pick the Preset button you wantfor that station. Press the buttonand hold it until you hear a beep.

Repeat steps 1 to 3 to store a totalof six stations on AM and twelveon FM.

Once a station’s frequency is stored,simply press and release the properPreset button to tune to it.

The preset frequencies will be lost ifyour car’s battery goes dead, isdisconnected, or the radio fuse isremoved.

Use the TUNE, SEEK, or SCANfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.

1.

2.

3.

4.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Preset

116

SSTTEERREEOO IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

AAUUTTOO SSEELLEECCTT BBUUTTTTOONN

SSCCAANN BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB SSEEEEKK BBAARR TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

SSCCAANN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:03:23 31S5A610_119

Page 120: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive the stations youpreset, you can use the Auto Selectfeature to find stations in the localarea.

To activate Auto Select, press theA. SEL button. A. SEL will appear inthe display, and the system will gointo scan mode for several seconds.It automatically scans both bands,looking for stations with strongsignals. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM stations and twelve FMstations in the preset buttons. Youcan then use the preset buttons toselect those stations.

If you are in a remote area, AutoSelect may not find six strong AMstations or twelve strong FM stations.If this happens, you will see a ‘‘0’’displayed when you press any presetbutton that does not have a stationstored.

Auto Select does not erase thefrequencies that you preset pre-viously. When you return home, turnoff Auto Select by pressing theA. SEL button. The preset buttonswill then select the frequencies youoriginally set.

If you do not like the stations AutoSelect has stored, you can storeother frequencies in the presetbuttons. Use the TUNE, SEEK, orSCAN function to find the desiredfrequencies, then store them in theselected preset buttons as describedpreviously.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

AUTO SELECT

117

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN AAUUTTOO SSEELLEECCTT BBUUTTTTOONN

SSCCAANN BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB SSEEEEKK BBAARR TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

AAUUTTOO SSEELLEECCTT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:03:32 31S5A610_120

Page 121: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Use these modes toadjust the tone to your liking. SelectTRE or BAS by pressing the TUNEknob. Adjust the desired mode byturning the TUNE knob. The levelnumber on the display shows you therange.

The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about five seconds after youstop adjusting a mode with theTUNE knob.

For information, See page .

Bass, Treble, Balance, and Fader areeach adjustable. You select which ofthese you want to adjust by pressingthe TUNE knob. The mode changesfrom BAS to TRE to FAD to BAL,and then back to the selected audiomode, each time you press theTUNE knob. Each mode is shown inthe display as it changes.

Select BAL or FAD by pressing theTUNE knob. Adjust the Balance orFader to your liking by turning theTUNE knob. The level number onthe display shows you the range.

These twomodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.BAL adjusts the side-to-side strength,while FAD adjusts the front-to-backstrength.

144

Comfort and Convenience Features

Audio System

Adjusting the Sound

Treble/Bass

Radio Frequencies and Reception

Balance/Fader

118

LLEEVVEELL NNUUMMBBEERR IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

01/06/02 17:03:42 31S5A610_121

Page 122: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is turned off.

The audio system display usuallyshows the time when the ignitionswitch is in ACCESSORY (I) or ON(II). It shows the operation mode ofthe radio, optional cassette player, oroptional CD player/changer whenyou operate them, then goes back tothe time display after five seconds.

To set the hours, press the H (Preset4) button while pressing the CLOCKbutton. Press and hold the H buttonuntil the hour advances to thedesired time.

To set the minutes, press the M(Preset 5) button while pressing the

CLOCK button. Press and hold theM button until the minutes numbersadvance to the desired time.

You can quickly set the time to thenearest hour. If the displayed time isbefore the half hour, the clock is setback to the previous hour bypressing and holding the CLOCKbutton, then pressing the RESET(Preset 6) button. If the displayedtime is after the half hour, the clockis set forward to the beginning of the

next hour.

1:06 would RESET to 1:00.1:52 would RESET to 2:00.

For example:

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, the time setting will belost. To set the time again, follow thesetting procedure.

71

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Audio System Lighting

Digital Clock

119

CCLLOOCCKK BBUUTTTTOONN

RREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONN

MM BBUUTTTTOONN

HH BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:03:54 31S5A610_122

Page 123: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The cassette system features Dolbynoise reduction, automatic sensing ofchromium-dioxide (CrO ) tape, andautoreverse for continuous play.

To operate the cassette player, theignition switch must be inACCESSORY(I) or ON(II). Makesure the tape opening on the cassetteis facing to the right, then insert thecassette most of the way into the slot.The system will pull it in the rest ofthe way, and begin to play.

The tape direction indicator will lightto show you which side of thecassette is playing. The indicatesthe side you inserted facing upwardis now playing. If you want to playthe other side, press the PLAY/PROG button.

Dolby noise reduction turns on whenyou insert a cassette. The indi-cator will light in the display. If thetape was not recorded with Dolbynoise reduction, turn it off bypressing the NR button.

Noise reduction remains off until youturn it on by pressing the button

again.

If you turn the system off while atape is playing, either with the PWR/VOL knob or by turning off theignition, the cassette will remain inthe drive. When you turn the systemback on, the tape will begin playingwhere it left off.

When the system reaches the end ofthe tape, it will automatically reversedirection and play the other side. Ifyou want to remove the cassettefrom the drive, press the EJECTbutton on the cassette player.

To switch to the radio or optional CDplayer/changer while listening to atape, press the AM/FM or CD/TAPE button. To change back to thecassette player, press the CD/TAPEbutton.

2

Dolby noise reduction manufactured underlicense from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corpo-ration. ‘‘DOLBY’’ and the double-D symbol

are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Operating the Optional CassettePlayer

120

01/06/02 17:04:05 31S5A610_123

Page 124: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

With a cassette playing, you can usethe FF, REW, SKIP, or REPEATfunction to find a desired program.

Fast Forward and Re-wind move the tape rapidly. To re-wind the tape, push the REW button.You will see REW in the display. Tofast forward the tape, push the FFbutton. You will see FF displayed.Press the PLAY/PROG button totake the system out of rewind or fastforward. If the system reaches theend of the tape while in fast forwardor rewind, it automatically stops thatfunction, reverses direction, andbegins to play.

The Skip Function allowsyou to find the beginning of a songor passage. To find the beginning ofthe song or passage currentlyplaying, push the lower part of theSKIP bar. You will see REW flashingin the display as the tape rewinds. To

find the beginning of the next song,push the upper part of the SKIP bar.You will see FF flashing in thedisplay as the tape fast forwards.When the system finds thebeginning of a song or passage, itgoes back to PLAY mode.

CONTINUED

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Tape Search Functions

FF/REW

SKIP

121

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

CCDD//TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEWW BBUUTTTTOONN

PPLLAAYY//PPRROOGG BBUUTTTTOONN

FFFF BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATT BBUUTTTTOONN

SSKKIIPP BBAARR NNRR IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB NNRR BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:04:15 31S5A610_124

Page 125: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- The Repeat functioncontinuously replays the currentsong or passage. Press the RPTbutton to activate it; you will see RPTdisplayed as a reminder. When thesystem reaches the end of the songor passage currently playing, it willautomatically go into rewind. Whenit senses the beginning of the samesong or passage, the system returnsto PLAY mode. It will continue torepeat this same program until youdeactivate REPEAT by pressing thebutton again.

The SKIP and REPEAT functionsuse silent periods on the tape to findthe end of a song or passage. Thesefeatures may not work to yoursatisfaction if there is almost no gapbetween selections, a high noiselevel between selections, or a silentperiod in the middle of a selection.

Damaged cassettes can jam insidethe drive or cause other problems.See page for information oncassette care and protection.

156

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Caring for Cassettes

REPEAT

122

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN RREEWW BBUUTTTTOONN

PPLLAAYY//PPRROOGG BBUUTTTTOONN

FFFF BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATT BBUUTTTTOONN

SSKKIIPP BBAARR

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB NNRR BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

CCDD//TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:04:23 31S5A610_125

Page 126: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

--

++

A trunk-mounted Compact Discchanger is available from your dealer.It holds up to six discs, providingseveral hours of continuousentertainment. You operate the CDchanger with the same controls usedfor the radio.

Your dealer also has an accessory in-dash single CD player available thatis operated by the radio controls. Tooperate this unit, use the instructions(except for those relating to multiplediscs) in this section.

To operate the CD changer or player,the ignition must be in ACCESSORY(I) or ON (II) and the audio systemmust be on.

CONTINUED

Operating the Optional CDPlayer/Changer

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 123

RRAANNDDOOMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

DDIISSCC BBUUTTTTOONN

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN RREEPPEEAATT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR RREEPPEEAATT BBUUTTTTOONN

RRAANNDDOOMM BBUUTTTTOONNCCDD//TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

DDIISSCC BBUUTTTTOONNSSEEEEKK//SSKKIIPP BBAARR

01/06/02 17:04:32 31S5A610_126

Page 127: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

+ -

+-

Press the CD/TAPE button. You willsee ‘‘CDC’’ in the display. Thesystem will start to play the firsttrack of the first disc. When that discends, the next disc in the magazineis loaded and played. After the lastdisc finishes, the system returns todisc 1.

To select a different disc, press theDISC (Preset 6) or DISC(Preset 5) button. The next disc inthe changer is loaded and playedwhen you press the DISC button.DISC loads and plays the previousdisc. If you select an empty slot inthe magazine, the changer will, afterfinding that slot empty, try to loadthe CD in the next slot. Thiscontinues until it finds a CD to loadand play.

Insert the disc into the CD slot. Pushthe disc in halfway, the drive will pullit in the rest of the way. Push theCD/TAPE button and the disc willstart to play.

You will see the track number beingplayed in the display.

You can also play 3-inch (8-cm) discswithout using an adapter ring. In allcases, play only standard round discs.Odd-shaped CDs may jam in thedrive or cause other problems.

Press the EJECT button to removethe disc from the player.

When the system reaches the end ofthe disc, it will return to the begin-ning and play that disc again.

For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.

If you eject the disc, but do notremove it from the slot, the systemwill automatically reload the discafter 15 seconds and put the CDplayer in pause mode. To beginplaying the disc, press the CD/TAPEbutton.

Using the instructions that camewith the changer, load the desiredCDs in the magazine, and load themagazine in the changer. Play onlystandard round discs. Odd-shapedCDs may jam in the drive or causeother problems.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

CD Player

CD Changer

124

01/06/02 17:04:44 31S5A610_127

Page 128: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When you activate theRepeat feature by pressing the RPTbutton, the system continuouslyreplays the current track. You willsee RPT in the display as a reminder.Press the RPT button again to turn itoff.

This feature,when activated, plays the tracks on aCD in random order, rather than inthe order they are recorded on theCD. To activate Random Play, pressthe RDM button. You will see RDMin the display. The system will thenselect and play tracks randomly onthe current disc. When all tracks onthat disc have been played, the nextdisc is loaded and played randomly.This continues until you deactivateRandom Play by pressing the RDMbutton again.

If you push and hold the SEEK/SKIP bar, the system will continue tomove across tracks. Release the barwhen you think it has reached thedesired place on the disc.

You can use the SEEK/SKIP bar toselect tracks within a disc. If youpress and release the SEEK/SKIPbar, the system will move to thebeginning of a track. Press the

side to move to the beginningof the next track, and the sideto move to the beginning of thecurrent track.

To take the system out of CD mode,press the AM/FM button or insert acassette in the player. If a tape isalready in the cassette player, pressthe CD/TAPE button. When youreturn to CD mode, play will contin-ue at the same point that it left off.

If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or the ignition switch, play willcontinue at the same point when youturn it back on.

For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see page

.

For information, See page .

For information, See page .

151

152

150

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

REPEAT

RANDOM PLAY

Protecting Compact Discs

CD Player Error Indications

CD Changer Error Indications

CD Player and Changer

125

01/06/02 17:04:57 31S5A610_128

Page 129: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your Honda’s audio system providesclear reception on both AM and FMbands, while the preset buttons allowyou to easily select your favoritestations.

The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to is displayed.To change bands, press the AM/FMbutton. On the FM band, ST will bedisplayed if the station is broadcast-ing in stereo. Stereo reproduction onAM is not available.

The cassette system features Dolbynoise reduction, automatic sensing ofchromium-dioxide (CrO ) tape, andautoreverse for continuous play.

The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) tooperate the audio system. Turn thesystem on by pushing the PWR/VOL knob or the AM/FM button.Adjust the volume by turning thePWR/VOL knob.

2

Dolby noise reduction manufactured underlicense from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corpo-ration. ‘‘DOLBY’’ and the double-D symbol

are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.

For LX model in the U.S.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

AM/FM/Cassette Stereo AudioSystem

Operating the Radio

126

SSTTEERREEOO IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN SSCCAANN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

AAUUTTOOSSEELLEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBBPPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

SSEEEEKK//SSKKIIPP BBAARR SSCCAANN//RREEPPEEAATT BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:05:07 31S5A610_129

Page 130: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- -

CONTINUED

You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, AUTOSELECT, and the Preset buttons.

Use the TUNE knob totune the radio to a desired frequency.Turn the TUNE knob to the right totune to a higher frequency, or to theleft to tune to a lower frequency.Turn the knob right or left until thedisplay reaches the desiredfrequency.

The SEEK functionsearches the band for a station witha strong signal. To activate it, pressthe SEEK bar on either the or

side, then release it.Depending on which side you press,the system scans upward or down-ward from the current frequency. Itstops when it finds a station with astrong signal.

The SCAN functionsamples all the stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. When the system isin the SCAN mode, SCAN shows inthe display. The system will scan upthe band for a station with a strongsignal. When it finds one, it will stopand play that station forapproximately five seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and playthat for five seconds. When it plays astation that you want to continuelistening to, press the SCAN buttonagain.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

TUNE

SEEK SCAN

127

01/06/02 17:05:14 31S5A610_130

Page 131: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- You can store thefrequencies of your favorite radiostations in the six preset buttons.Each button will store one frequencyon the AM band, and twofrequencies on the FM band.

To store a frequency:

Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each Presetbutton.

Pick the Preset button you wantfor that station. Press the buttonand hold it until you hear a beep.

Repeat steps 1 to 3 to store a totalof six stations on AM and twelveon FM.

Once a station’s frequency is stored,simply press and release the properpreset button to tune to it.

The preset frequencies will be lost ifyour car’s battery goes dead, isdisconnected, or the radio fuse isremoved.

Use the TUNE, SEEK, or SCANfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.

1.

2.

3.

4.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Preset

128

SSTTEERREEOO IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN SSCCAANN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSEEEEKK BBAARR SSCCAANN BBUUTTTTOONN

AAUUTTOOSSEELLEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBBPPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

01/06/02 17:05:24 31S5A610_131

Page 132: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive the stations youpreset, you can use the Auto Selectfeature to find stations in the localarea.

To activate Auto Select, press theA. SEL button. A. SEL will appear inthe display, and the system will gointo scan mode for several seconds.It automatically scans both bands,looking for stations with strongsignals. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM stations and twelve FMstations in the preset buttons. Youcan then use the preset buttons toselect those stations.

If you are in a remote area, AutoSelect may not find six strong AMstations or twelve strong FM stations.If this happens, you will see a ‘‘0’’displayed when you press any presetbutton that does not have a stationstored.

Auto Select does not erase thefrequencies that you preset pre-viously. When you return home, turnoff Auto Select by pressing theA. SEL button. The preset buttonswill then select the frequencies youoriginally set.

If you do not like the stations AutoSelect has stored, you can storeother frequencies in the presetbuttons. Use the TUNE, SEEK, orSCAN function to find the desiredfrequencies, then store them in theselected preset buttons as describedpreviously.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

AUTO SELECT

129

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

SSCCAANN BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

SSEEEEKK BBAARR

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

AAUUTTOO SSEELLEECCTT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

AAUUTTOOSSEELLEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

01/06/02 17:05:32 31S5A610_132

Page 133: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about five seconds after youstop adjusting a mode with theTUNE knob.

For information, See page .

Bass, Treble, Balance, and Fader areeach adjustable. You select which ofthese you want to adjust by pressingthe TUNE knob. The mode changesfrom BAS to TRE to FAD to BAL,and then back to the selected audiomode, each time you press theTUNE knob. Each mode is shown inthe display as it changes.

These twomodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.BAL adjusts the side-to-side strength,while FAD adjusts the front-to-backstrength.

Select BAL or FAD by pressing theTUNE knob. Adjust the Balance orFader to your liking by turning theTUNE knob.The displayed number shows youthe current setting.When the adjustment level reachesthe center, you will see ‘‘ ’’.

Use these modes toadjust the tone to your liking. SelectTRE or BAS by pressing the TUNEknob. Adjust the desired mode byturning the TUNE knob.The displayed number shows youthe current setting.When the adjustment level reachesthe center, you will see ‘‘ ’’.

144

Comfort and Convenience Features

Audio System

Adjusting the Sound

Radio Frequencies and Reception

Balance/Fader

Treble/Bass

130

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

AAddjjuussttmmeenntt LLeevveell

01/06/02 17:05:44 31S5A610_133

Page 134: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is turned off.

The audio system display usuallyshows the time when the ignitionswitch is in ACCESSORY (I) or ON(II). It shows the operation mode ofthe radio, cassette player, or optionalCD player/changer when youoperate them, then goes back to thetime display after five seconds.

If an error occurs while operatingthe optional CD player or changer,the display will keep showing theerror code and will not switch to thetime display until the error iscorrected (see pages and ).

You can set the time only when theclock is displayed.

To set the hours, press the H (Preset4) button while pressing the CLOCK(SCAN/RPT) button. Press and holdthe H button until the hour advancesto the desired time.

To set the minutes, press the M(Preset 5) button while pressing theCLOCK (SCAN/RPT) button. Pressand hold the M button until theminutes numbers advance to thedesired time.

71

152151

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Audio System Lighting

Digital Clock

131

CCLLOOCCKK BBUUTTTTOONN

RREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONN

MM BBUUTTTTOONN

HH BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:05:55 31S5A610_134

Page 135: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

1:06 would RESET to 1:001:52 would RESET to 2:00

For example:

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, the time setting will belost. To set the time again, follow thesetting procedure.

To operate the cassette player, theignition switch must be inACCESSORY(I) or ON(II). Makesure the tape opening on the cassetteis facing to the right, then insert thecassette most of the way into the slot.The system will pull it in the rest ofthe way, and begin to play.

The tape direction indicator will lightto show you which side of thecassette is playing. The indicatesthe side you inserted facing upwardis now playing. If you want to playthe other side, press the PLAY/PROG button.

You can quickly set the time to thenearest hour. If the displayed time isbefore the half hour, the clock is setback to the previous hour bypressing and holding the CLOCK(SCAN/RPT) button, then pressingthe RESET (Preset 6) button. If thedisplayed time is after the half hour,the clock is set forward to thebeginning of the next hour.

Operating the Cassette Player

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features132

RREEWW BBUUTTTTOONN

EEJJEECCTT BBUUTTTTOONN

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATTBBUUTTTTOONN

CCAASSSSEETTTTEE SSLLOOTT

PPLLAAYY//PPRROOGG BBUUTTTTOONN

CCDD//TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

SSKKIIPP BBAARR

FFFF BBUUTTTTOONN

NNOOIISSEE RREEDDUUCCTTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

NNOOIISSEERREEDDUUCCTTIIOONNIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:06:05 31S5A610_135

Page 136: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

The Skip Function allowsyou to find the beginning of a songor passage. To find the beginning ofthe song or passage currentlyplaying, push the lower part of theSKIP bar. You will see REW flashingin the display as the tape rewinds. Tofind the beginning of the next song,push the upper part of the SKIP bar.You will see FF flashing in thedisplay as the tape fast forwards.When the system finds thebeginning of a song or passage, itgoes back to PLAY mode.

To switch to the radio or optional CDchanger while listening to a tape,press the AM/FM or CD/TAPEbutton. To change back to thecassette player, press the CD/TAPEbutton.

With a cassette playing, you can usethe FF, REW, SKIP, or REPEATfunction to find a desired program.

Dolby noise reduction turns on whenyou insert a cassette. The indi-cator will light in the display. If thetape was not recorded with Dolbynoise reduction, turn it off bypressing the button.

Noise reduction remains off until youturn it on by pressing the buttonagain.

When the system reaches the end ofthe tape, it will automatically reversedirection and play the other side. Ifyou want to remove the cassettefrom the drive, press the EJECTbutton.

If you turn the system off while atape is playing, either with the PWR/VOL knob or by turning off theignition, the cassette will remain inthe drive. When you turn the systemback on, the tape will begin playingwhere it left off.

Fast Forward and Re-wind move the tape rapidly. To re-wind the tape, push the REW button.You will see REW in the display. Tofast forward the tape, push the FFbutton. You will see FF displayed.Press the PLAY/PROG button totake the system out of rewind or fastforward. If the system reaches theend of the tape while in fast forwardor rewind, it automatically stops thatfunction, reverses direction, andbegins to play.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

SKIP

Tape Search Functions

FF/REW

133

01/06/02 17:06:15 31S5A610_136

Page 137: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- The Repeat functioncontinuously replays the currentsong or passage. Press the RPTbutton to activate it; you will see RPTdisplayed as a reminder. When thesystem reaches the end of the songor passage currently playing, it willautomatically go into rewind. Whenit senses the beginning of the samesong or passage, the system returnsto PLAY mode. It will continue torepeat this same program until youdeactivate REPEAT by pressing thebutton again.

The SKIP and REPEAT functionsuse silent periods on the tape to findthe end of a song or passage. Thesefeatures may not work to yoursatisfaction if there is almost no gapbetween selections, a high noiselevel between selections, or a silentperiod in the middle of a selection.

Damaged cassettes can jam insidethe drive or cause other problems.See page for information oncassette care and protection.

156

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

REPEAT

Caring for Cassettes

134

FFFF BBUUTTTTOONNRREEWW BBUUTTTTOONN

EEJJEECCTT BBUUTTTTOONN

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATTIINNDDIICCAATTOORR

RREEPPEEAATTBBUUTTTTOONN

CCAASSSSEETTTTEE SSLLOOTT

CCDD//TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN SSKKIIPP BBAARR

PPLLAAYY//PPRROOGG BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB NNOOIISSEE RREEDDUUCCTTIIOONN BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:06:24 31S5A610_137

Page 138: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

--

++

CONTINUED

Your dealer also has an accessory in-dash single CD player available thatis operated by the radio controls. Tooperate this unit, use the instructions(except for those relating to multiplediscs) in this section.

To operate the CD changer or player,the ignition must be in ACCESSORY(I) or ON (II) and the audio systemmust be on.

A trunk-mounted Compact Discchanger is available from your dealer.It holds up to six discs, providingseveral hours of continuousentertainment. You operate the CDchanger with the same controls usedfor the radio and cassette player.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Operating the Optional CDPlayer/Changer

135

RRAANNDDOOMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORRAAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

RRAANNDDOOMMBBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATTBBUUTTTTOONN

CCDD//TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN

SSEEEEKK//SSKKIIPP BBAARR

DDIISSCC BBUUTTTTOONN

DDIISSCC BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:06:32 31S5A610_138

Page 139: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

+ -

+-

Press the CD/TAPE button. You willsee ‘‘CDC’’ in the display. Thesystem will start to play the firsttrack of the first disc. When that discends, the next disc in the magazineis loaded and played. After the lastdisc finishes, the system returns todisc 1.

To select a different disc, press theDISC (Preset 6) or DISC(Preset 5) button. The next disc inthe changer is loaded and playedwhen you press the DISC button.DISC loads and plays the previousdisc. If you select an empty slot inthe magazine, the changer will, afterfinding that slot empty, try to loadthe CD in the next slot. Thiscontinues until it finds a CD to loadand play.

Insert the disc into the CD slot. Pushthe disc in halfway, the drive will pullit in the rest of the way. Push theCD/TAPE button and the disc willstart to play.

You will see the track number beingplayed in the display.

You can also play 3-inch (8-cm) discswithout using an adapter ring. In allcases, play only standard round discs.Odd-shaped CDs may jam in thedrive or cause other problems.

For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.

Using the instructions that camewith the changer, load the desiredCDs in the magazine, and load themagazine in the changer. Play onlystandard round discs. Odd-shapedCDs may jam in the drive or causeother problems.

If you eject the disc, but do notremove it from the slot, the systemwill automatically reload the discafter 15 seconds and put the CDplayer in pause mode. To beginplaying the disc, press the CD/TAPEbutton.

Press the EJECT button to removethe disc from the player.

When the system reaches the end ofthe disc, it will return to the begin-

ning and play that disc again.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

CD Player

CD Changer

136

01/06/02 17:06:45 31S5A610_139

Page 140: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When you activate theRepeat feature by pressing the RPTbutton, the system continuouslyreplays the current track. You willsee RPT in the display as a reminder.Press the RPT button again to turn itoff.

This feature,when activated, plays the tracks on aCD in random order, rather than inthe order they are recorded on theCD. To activate Random Play, pressthe RDM button. You will see RDMin the display. The system will thenselect and play tracks randomly onthe current disc. When all tracks onthat disc have been played, the nextdisc is loaded and played randomly.This continues until you deactivateRandom Play by pressing the RDMbutton again.

If you push and hold the SEEK/SKIP bar, the system will continue tomove across tracks. Release the barwhen you think it has reached thedesired place on the disc.

You can use the SEEK/SKIP bar toselect tracks within a disc. If youpress and release the SEEK/SKIPbar, the system will move to thebeginning of a track. Press the

side to move to the beginningof the next track, and the sideto move to the beginning of thecurrent track.

To take the system out of CD mode,press the AM/FM button or insert acassette in the player. If a tape isalready in the cassette player, pressthe CD/TAPE button. When youreturn to CD mode, play will contin-ue at the same point that it left off.

If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or the ignition switch, play willcontinue at the same point when youturn it back on.

For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see page

.

For information, See page .

For information, See page .

151

152

150

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

REPEAT

RANDOM PLAY

Protecting Compact Discs

CD Player Error Indications

CD Changer Error Indications

CD Player and Changer

137

01/06/02 17:06:58 31S5A610_140

Page 141: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to is displayed.To change bands, press the AM/FMbutton. On the FM band, ST will bedisplayed if the station is broadcast-ing in stereo. Stereo reproduction onAM is not available.

Your Honda’s audio system providesclear reception on both AM and FMbands, while the preset buttons allowyou to easily select your favoritestations.

The anti-theft feature will disable thesystem if it is disconnected from thecar’s battery. To get the systemworking again, you must enter acode number (see page ).

The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) tooperate the audio system. Turn thesystem on by pushing the PWR/VOL knob or the AM/FM button.Adjust the volume by turning thePWR/VOL knob.

157

For EX model in the U.S., and LX andDX-GOP models in Canada

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

AM/FM/CD Audio System

Operating the Radio

138

SSTTEERREEOO IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

SSEEEEKK BBAARR

AAUUTTOOSSEELLEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBBPPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

SSCCAANN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSCCAANNBBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:07:09 31S5A610_141

Page 142: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- -

CONTINUED

You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, AUTOSELECT, and the Preset buttons.

Use the TUNE knob totune the radio to a desired frequency.Turn the TUNE knob to the right totune to a higher frequency, or to theleft to tune to a lower frequency.Turn the knob right or left until thedisplay reaches the desiredfrequency.

The SEEK functionsearches the band for a station witha strong signal. To activate it, pressthe SEEK bar on either the or

side, then release it.Depending on which side you press,the system scans upward or down-ward from the current frequency. Itstops when it finds a station with astrong signal.

The SCAN functionsamples all the stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. When the system isin the SCAN mode, SCAN shows inthe display. The system will scan upthe band for a station with a strongsignal. When it finds one, it will stopand play that station forapproximately five seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and playthat for five seconds. When it plays astation that you want to continuelistening to, press the SCAN buttonagain.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

TUNE

SEEK SCAN

139

01/06/02 17:07:16 31S5A610_142

Page 143: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Repeat steps 1 to 3 to store a totalof six stations on AM and twelveon FM.

Pick the Preset button you wantfor that station. Press the buttonand hold it until you hear a beep.

Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each Presetbutton.

To store a frequency:

Once a station’s frequency is stored,simply press and release the properpreset button to tune to it.

The preset frequencies will be lost ifyour car’s battery goes dead, isdisconnected, or the radio fuse isremoved.

You can store thefrequencies of your favorite radiostations in the six preset buttons.Each button will store one frequencyon the AM band, and twofrequencies on the FM band.

Use the TUNE, SEEK, or SCANfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.

1.

2.

3.

4.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Preset

140

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN SSTTEERREEOO IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSCCAANN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

SSEEEEKK BBAARRPPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

AAUUTTOOSSEELLEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

SSCCAANNBBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

01/06/02 17:07:27 31S5A610_143

Page 144: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive the stations youpreset, you can use the Auto Selectfeature to find stations in the localarea.

To activate Auto Select, press theA. SEL button. A. SEL will flash inthe display, and the system will gointo scan mode for several seconds.It automatically scans both bands,looking for stations with strongsignals. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM stations and twelve FMstations in the preset buttons. Youcan then use the preset buttons toselect those stations.

Auto Select does not erase thefrequencies that you preset pre-viously. When you return home, turnoff Auto Select by pressing theA. SEL button. The preset buttonswill then select the frequencies youoriginally set.

If you are in a remote area, AutoSelect may not find six strong AMstations or twelve strong FM stations.If this happens, you will see a ‘‘0’’displayed when you press any presetbutton that does not have a stationstored.

If you do not like the stations AutoSelect has stored, you can storeother frequencies in the presetbuttons. Use the TUNE, SEEK, orSCAN function to find the desiredfrequencies, then store them in theselected preset buttons as describedpreviously.

AUTO SELECT

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 141

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

SSEEEEKK BBAARRPPRREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONNSS

AAUUTTOOSSEELLEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

SSCCAANNBBUUTTTTOONN

AAUUTTOO SSEELLEECCTT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

01/06/02 17:07:35 31S5A610_144

Page 145: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about five seconds after youstop adjusting a mode with theTUNE knob.

Bass, Treble, Balance, and Fader areeach adjustable. You select which ofthese you want to adjust by pressingthe TUNE knob. The mode changesfrom BAS to TRE to FAD to BAL,and then back to the selected audiomode, each time you press theTUNE knob. Each mode is shown inthe display as it changes.

These twomodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.BAL adjusts the side-to-side strength,while FAD adjusts the front-to-backstrength.

Select BAL or FAD by pressing theTUNE knob. Adjust the Balance orFader to your liking by turning theTUNE knob.The displayed number shows youthe current setting.When the adjustment level reachesthe center, you will see ‘‘ ’’.

Use these modes toadjust the tone to your liking. SelectTRE or BAS by pressing the TUNEknob. Adjust the desired mode byturning the TUNE knob.The displayed number shows youthe current setting.When the adjustment level reachesthe center, you will see ‘‘ ’’.

Comfort and Convenience Features

Audio System

Adjusting the Sound

Balance/Fader

Treble/Bass

142

TTUUNNEE KKNNOOBB

AAddjjuussttmmeenntt LLeevveell

01/06/02 17:07:46 31S5A610_145

Page 146: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The display of your audio systemusually shows the time when theignition switch is in ACCESSORY (I)or ON (II). It shows the operationmode of the radio, CD player, oroptional CD changer/cassette playerwhen you operate them, and goesback to the time display after fiveseconds.

You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is turned off.

If an error occurs while operatingthe CD player or optional CDchanger, the display will show theerror code and will not switch to thetime display until the error iscorrected (see pages and ).

You can set the time only when theclock is displayed.

To set the hours, press the H (Preset4) button while pressing the CLOCK(SCAN/RPT) button. Press and holdthe H button until the hour advancesto the desired time.

To set the minutes, press the M(Preset 5) button while pressing theCLOCK (SCAN/RPT) button. Pressand hold the M button until theminutes numbers advance to thedesired time.

152151

71

CONTINUED

Audio System Lighting

Digital Clock

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features 143

CCLLOOCCKK BBUUTTTTOONN

HH BBUUTTTTOONN

MM BBUUTTTTOONN RREESSEETT BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:07:57 31S5A610_146

Page 147: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your Honda’s radio can receive thecomplete AM and FM bands.Those bands cover these frequen-cies:

AM band:530 to 1,710 kilohertzFM band:87.7 to 107.9 megahertz

Radio stations on the AM band areassigned frequencies at least tenkilohertz apart (530, 540, 550).Stations on the FM band areassigned frequencies at least 0.2megahertz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3).

Stations must use these exactfrequencies. It is fairly common forstations to round-off the frequency intheir advertising, so your radio coulddisplay a frequency of 100.9 eventhough the announcer may identifythe station as ‘‘FM101.’’

For example:1:06 would RESET to 1:00.1:52 would RESET to 2:00.

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, the time setting will belost. To set the time again, follow thesetting procedure.

You can quickly set the time to thenearest hour. If the displayed time isbefore the half hour, the clock is setback to the previous hour bypressing and holding the CLOCK(SCAN/RPT) button, then pressingthe RESET (Preset 6) button. If thedisplayed time is after the half hour,the clock is set forward to thebeginning of the next hour.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Radio Frequencies

144

01/06/02 17:08:09 31S5A610_147

Page 148: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Driving very near the transmitter ofa station that is broadcasting on afrequency close to the frequency ofthe station you are listening to canalso affect your radio’s reception.You may temporarily hear bothstations, or hear only the station youare close to.

A radio station’s signal gets weakeras you get farther away from itstransmitter. If you are listening to anAM station, you will notice the soundvolume becoming weaker, and thestation drifting in and out. If you arelistening to an FM station, you willsee the stereo indicator flickering offand on as the signal weakens.Eventually, the stereo indicator willgo off and the sound will fadecompletely as you get out of range ofthe station’s signal.

How well your Honda’s radioreceives stations is dependent onmany factors, such as the distancefrom the station’s transmitter,nearby large objects, and atmos-pheric conditions.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Radio Reception

145

01/06/02 17:08:17 31S5A610_148

Page 149: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Radio signals, especially on the FMband, are deflected by large objectssuch as buildings and hills. Yourradio then receives both the directsignal from the station’s transmitter,and the deflected signal. This causesthe sound to distort or flutter. This isa main cause of poor radio receptionin city driving.

Radio reception can be affected byatmospheric conditions such asthunderstorms, high humidity, andeven sunspots. You may be able toreceive a distant radio station oneday and not receive it the next daybecause of a change in conditions.

Electrical interference from passingvehicles and stationary sources cancause temporary reception problems.

As required by the FCC:Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features146

01/06/02 17:08:25 31S5A610_149

Page 150: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

You operate the CD player with thesame controls used for the radio.

With the ignition switch inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II), insertthe disc into the CD slot. Push thedisc in halfway, the drive will pull itin the rest of the way and begin toplay. The number of the track that isplaying is shown in the display.

You can also play 3-inch (8-cm) discswithout using an adapter ring. Playonly standard round discs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the drive orcause other problems.

For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Operating the CD Player

147

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

CCDD//TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN RREEPPEEAATT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

RRAANNDDOOMM BBUUTTTTOONN

SSEEEEKK//SSKKIIPP BBAARR

RRAANNDDOOMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

EEJJEECCTTBBUUTTTTOONN

SSCCAANN//RREEPPEEAATT BBUUTTTTOONN

CCDD SSLLOOTT

01/06/02 17:08:35 31S5A610_150

Page 151: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Each time you press and release theside of the SEEK/SKIP bar,

the system skips forward to thebeginning of the next track. Pressthe side to skip backward to thebeginning of the current track. Pressit again to skip to the beginning ofthe previous track.

You can use the SEEK/SKIP barwhile a disc is playing to selectpassages and change tracks.

To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the SEEK/SKIP bar. Pressthe side to move forward. Youwill see CUE in the display. Press the

side to move backward. Youwill see REW displayed. Release thebar when the system reaches thepoint you want.

To activate the Repeatfeature, press and release the RPTbutton. You will see RPT in thedisplay. The system continuouslyreplays the current track. Press theRPT button again to turn it off.

This feature,when activated, plays the tracks onthe CD in random order, rather thanin the order they are recorded on theCD. To activate Random Play, pressthe RDM button. You will see RDMin the display. The system will thenselect and play tracks randomly.This continues until you deactivateRandom Play by pressing the RDMbutton again.

If you eject the disc, but do notremove it from the slot, the systemwill automatically reload the discafter 15 seconds and put the CDplayer in pause mode. To beginplaying the disc, press the CD button.

Press the eject button to remove thedisc from the drive.

If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or by turning off the ignition,the disc will stay in the drive. Whenyou turn the system back on, the CDwill begin playing where it left off.

You can switch to the radio while aCD is playing by pressing the AM/FM button. Press the CD button toreturn to playing the CD. The CDwill begin playing where it left off.

When the system reaches the end ofthe disc, it will return to the begin-ning and play that disc again.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

REPEAT

RANDOM PLAY

148

01/06/02 17:08:48 31S5A610_151

Page 152: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

+ -

+-

Load the desired CDs in themagazine and load the magazine inthe changer according to theinstructions that came with the unit.Play only standard round discs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the drive orcause other problems.

If you eject the disc in the in-dashCD while it is playing, the systemwill automatically switch to the CDchanger and begin play where it leftoff. If there are no CDs in thechanger, the display will flash. Youwill have to select another mode(AM or FM) with the button.

A trunk-mounted Compact Discchanger is available from your dealer.It holds up to six discs, providingseveral hours of continuousentertainment. You operate this CDchanger with the same controls usedfor the in-dash CD player.

If you load a CD in the in-dash playerwhile the changer is playing a CD,the system will stop the changer andbegin playing the in-dash CD. Toselect the changer again, press theCD button. Play will begin where itleft off. Use the CD button to switchbetween the player and the changer.

To select a different disc, press theDISC (Preset 6) or DISC(Preset 5) button. The next disc inthe changer is loaded and playedwhen you press the DISC button.DISC loads and plays the previousdisc. If you select an empty slot inthe magazine, the changer will, afterfinding that slot empty, try to loadthe CD in the next slot. Thiscontinues until it finds a CD to loadand play.

To select the CD changer, press theCD button. The disc and tracknumbers will be displayed.

For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.

To use the SKIP, REPEAT, andRANDOM functions, refer to the in-dash player operating instructions.

When you switch back to CD mode,the system selects the same unit (in-dash or changer) that was playingwhen you switched out of CD mode.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Operating the CD Changer(Optional)

149

01/06/02 17:08:59 31S5A610_152

Page 153: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When a CD is not being played, storeit in its case to protect it from dustand other contamination. To preventwarpage, keep CDs out of directsunlight and extreme heat.

To clean a disc, use a clean soft cloth.Wipe across the disc from the centerto the outside edge.

A new CD may be rough on theinner and outer edges. The smallplastic pieces causing this roughnesscan flake off and fall on the re-cording surface of the disc, causingskipping or other problems. Removethese pieces by rubbing the innerand outer edges with the side of apencil or pen.

Never try to insert foreign objects inthe CD player or the magazine.

Handle a CD by its edges; nevertouch either surface. Do not placestabilizer rings or labels on the CD.These and contamination fromfingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip penscan cause the CD to not playproperly, or possibly jam in the drive.

Protecting Compact Discs

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features150

01/06/02 17:09:09 31S5A610_153

Page 154: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDplayer, find the cause in the chart tothe right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the car to yourHonda dealer.

Indication SolutionCause

Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check if the disc is inserted correctly in the CDplayer.Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged.Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation.If the CD cannot be pulled out or the errorindication does not disappear after the disc isejected, see your Honda dealer.Do not try to force the disc out of the player.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.

FOCUS Error

Mechanical Error

High temperature

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

CD Player Error Indications

151

01/06/02 17:09:18 31S5A610_154

Page 155: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDchanger, find the cause in the chartto the right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the car to yourHonda dealer.

Indication SolutionCause

Press the magazine eject button and pull outthe magazine, check for error indication. Insertthe magazine again. If the code does notdisappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,consult your Honda dealer.Insert CD.

Press the magazine eject button and pull outthe magazine, check for error indication. Insertthe magazine again. If the code does notdisappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,consult your Honda dealer.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.Insert CD magazine.

FOCUS Error

No CD in the CDmagazine

Mechanical Error

High temperature

No CD magazine in theCD changer

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

CD Changer Error Indications

152

01/06/02 17:09:29 31S5A610_155

Page 156: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

The cassette system features Dolbynoise reduction, automatic sensing ofchromium-dioxide (CrO ) tape, andautoreverse for continuous play.

To operate the optional cassetteplayer, the ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) and theaudio system must be on.

Make sure the tape opening on thecassette is facing to the right, theninsert the cassette most of the wayinto the slot. The system will pull itin the rest of the way, and begin toplay.

2

Dolby noise reduction manufactured underlicense from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corpo-ration. ‘‘DOLBY’’ and the double-D symbol

are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Operating the Cassette Player(Optional)

153

NNRR BBUUTTTTOONN

PPWWRR//VVOOLL KKNNOOBB

AAMM//FFMM BBUUTTTTOONN

CCDD//TTAAPPEE BBUUTTTTOONN RREEPPEEAATT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

RREEWW BBUUTTTTOONN

PPLLAAYY//PPRROOGG BBUUTTTTOONN

FFFF BBUUTTTTOONN

RREEPPEEAATTBBUUTTTTOONN

SSKKIIPP BBAARR

NNOOIISSEE RREEDDUUCCTTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:09:40 31S5A610_156

Page 157: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

With a cassette playing, you can usethe FF, REW, SKIP, or REPEATfunction to find a desired program.

The tape direction indicator will lightto show you which side of thecassette is playing. The indicatesthe side you inserted facing upwardis now playing. If you want to playthe other side, press the PLAY/PROG button.

Dolby noise reduction turns on whenyou insert a cassette. The indi-cator will light in the display. If thetape was not recorded with Dolbynoise reduction, turn it off bypressing the NR button.

Noise reduction remains off until youturn it on by pressing the buttonagain.

When the system reaches the end ofthe tape, it will automatically reversedirection and play the other side. Ifyou want to remove the cassettefrom the drive, press the EJECTbutton on the cassette player.

If you turn the system off while atape is playing, either with the PWR/VOL knob or by turning off theignition, the cassette will remain inthe drive. When you turn the systemback on, the cassette player will be inpause mode. To begin playing, pressthe PLAY/PROG button.

To switch to the radio or CD playerwhile a tape is playing, press theAM/FM, or CD/TAPE button. Tochange back to the cassette player,press the CD/TAPE button.

Fast Forward and Re-wind move the tape rapidly. To re-wind the tape, push the REW button.You will see REW in the display. Tofast forward the tape, push the FFbutton. You will see FF displayed.Press the PLAY/PROG button totake the system out of rewind or fastforward. If the system reaches theend of the tape while in fast forwardor rewind, it automatically stops thatfunction, reverses direction, andbegins to play.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Tape Search Functions

FF/REW

154

01/06/02 17:09:50 31S5A610_157

Page 158: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

-- The SKIP and REPEAT functionsuse silent periods on the tape to findthe end of a song or passage. Thesefeatures may not work to yoursatisfaction if there is almost no gapbetween selections, a high noiselevel between selections, or a silentperiod in the middle of a selection.

The Repeat functioncontinuously replays the currentsong or passage. Press the RPTbutton to activate it; you will see RPTdisplayed as a reminder. When thesystem reaches the end of the songor passage currently playing, it willautomatically go into rewind. Whenit senses the beginning of the samesong or passage, the system returnsto PLAY mode. It will continue torepeat this same program until youdeactivate REPEAT by pressing thebutton again.

The Skip Function allowsyou to find the beginning of a songor passage. To find the beginning ofthe song or passage currentlyplaying, push the lower part of theSKIP bar. You will see REW flashingin the display as the tape rewinds. Tofind the beginning of the next song,push the upper part of the SKIP bar.You will see FF flashing in thedisplay as the tape fast forwards.When the system finds thebeginning of a song or passage, itgoes back to PLAY mode.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

REPEATSKIP

155

01/06/02 17:09:56 31S5A610_158

Page 159: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you do not clean the cassetteplayer regularly, it may eventuallybecome impossible to remove thecontamination with a normalcleaning kit.

Use 100-minute or shorter cassettes.Cassettes longer than that usethinner tape that may break or jamthe drive.

Look at the cassette before youinsert it. If the tape is loose, tightenit by turning a hub with a pencil oryour finger.

The cassette player picks up dirt andoxides from the tape. This contami-nation builds up over time andcauses the sound quality to degrade.To prevent this, you should clean theplayer after every 30 hours of use.Your dealer has a cleaning kitavailable.

Never try to insert foreign objectsinto the cassette player.

When they are not in use, storecassettes in their cases to protectthem from dust and moisture. Neverplace cassettes where they will beexposed to direct sunlight, high heat,or high humidity. If a cassette isexposed to extreme heat or cold, letit reach a moderate temperaturebefore inserting it in the player.

If the label is peeling off, remove itfrom the cassette or it could causethe cassette to jam in the player.Never try to insert a warped ordamaged cassette in the player.

If you see the error indication‘‘ ’’ on the display, pressthe EJECT button and remove thecassette from the unit. Make surethe tape is not damaged. If thecassette will not eject or the errorindication stays on after the cassetteejects, take the car to your Hondadealer.

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Caring for the Cassette Player

156

01/06/02 17:10:06 31S5A610_159

Page 160: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

You will have to store your favoritestations in the Preset buttons afterthe system begins working. Youroriginal settings were lost whenpower was disconnected.

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, or the radio fuse isremoved, the audio system willdisable itself. If this happens, youwill see ‘‘ ’’ in the frequencydisplay the next time you turn on thesystem. Use the Preset buttons toenter the five-digit code. If it isentered correctly, the radio will startplaying.

If you make a mistake entering thecode, do not start over or try tocorrect your mistake. Complete thefive-digit sequence, then enter thecorrect code. You have ten tries toenter the correct code. If you areunsuccessful in ten attempts, youmust then leave the system on forone hour before trying again.

Your car’s audio system will disableitself if it is disconnected fromelectrical power for any reason. Tomake it work again, the user mustenter a specific five-digit code in thePreset buttons. Because there arehundreds of number combinationspossible from five digits, making thesystem work without knowing theexact code is nearly impossible.

You should have received a card thatlists your audio system’s codenumber and serial number. It is bestto store this card in a safe place athome. In addition, you should writethe audio system’s serial number inthis Owner’s Manual. If you shouldhappen to lose the card, you mustobtain the code number from yourHonda dealer. To do this, you willneed the system’s serial number.

CONTINUED

On EX model in the U.S., and LX andDX-GOP models in Canada

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Theft Protection

157

01/06/02 17:10:16 31S5A610_160

Page 161: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When the audio system disablesitself, you can see the eight-digitaudio system serial number on thedisplay. To display the serialnumber:

Turn the ignition switch toACCESSORY (I) or ON (II).

Push the PWR/VOL knob to turnon the audio system whilepressing the Preset 1 and 6buttons at the same time.

You will see the first 4-digitnumber on the display for fiveseconds, then the next 4-digitnumber is shown for five seconds.You will see 8-digit serial numberin total. This procedure is repeatedonce again.

After you have entered the audiosystem’s code number correctly, theserial number will not be displayed.

1.

2.

3.

On EX model in the U.S., and LX andDX-GOP models in Canada

Audio System

Comfort and Convenience Features

Displaying Audio System’s SerialNumber

158

01/06/02 17:10:24 31S5A610_161

Page 162: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed above 25 mph (40 km/h).

Push in the Cruise Control MasterSwitch to the left of the steeringcolumn. The indicator in theswitch will light.

Cruise control allows you to maintaina set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h)without keeping your foot on theaccelerator pedal. It should be usedfor cruising on straight, openhighways. It is not recommended forconditions such as city driving,winding roads, slippery roads, heavyrain, or bad weather. You shouldhave full control of the car underthose conditions.

1.

2.

CONTINUED

On LX and EX models in the U.S., andLX model in Canada

Using the Cruise Control

Cruise Control

Comfort and Convenience Features 159

Improper use of the cruisecontrol can lead to a crash.

Use the cruise control onlywhen traveling on openhighways in good weather.

01/06/02 17:10:33 31S5A610_162

Page 163: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

You can increase the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:

Press and hold the RESUME/accel button. The car will acceler-ate. When you reach the desiredcruising speed, release the button.

Press and release the SET/decelbutton on the steering wheel. TheCRUISE CONTROL light on theinstrument panel comes on toshow the system is now activated.

The cruise control may not hold theset speed when you are going up anddown hills. If your speed increasesgoing down a hill, use the brakes toslow down to the desired speed. Thiswill cancel the cruise control. Toresume the set speed, press theRESUME/accel button. TheCRUISE CONTROL light on theinstrument panel comes on.

When climbing a steep hill, theautomatic transmission maydownshift to hold the set speed.

To increase your speed in verysmall amounts, tap the RESUME/accel button repeatedly. Each timeyou do this, your car will speed upabout 1 mph (1.6 km/h).

Push on the accelerator pedal. Ac-celerate to the desired cruisingspeed and press the SET/decelbutton.

3.

Changing the Set Speed

Comfort and Convenience Features

Cruise Control

160

RREESSUUMMEE//aacccceell

SSEETT//ddeecceell

01/06/02 17:10:43 31S5A610_163

Page 164: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Even with the cruise control turnedon, you can still use the acceleratorpedal to speed up for passing. Aftercompleting the pass, take your footoff the accelerator pedal. The carwill return to the set cruising speed.

Resting your foot on the brake orclutch pedal will cause the cruisecontrol to cancel.

You can decrease the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:

Press and hold the SET/decelbutton. The car will decelerate.Release the button when youreach the desired speed.

To slow down in very smallamounts, tap the SET/decelbutton repeatedly. Each time youdo this, your car will slow downabout 1 mph (1.6 km/h).

Tap the brake or clutch pedallightly with your foot. TheCRUISE CONTROL light on theinstrument panel will go out.When the car slows to the desiredspeed, press the SET/decel button.The car will then maintain thedesired speed.

Tap the brake or clutch pedal.

You can cancel the cruise control inany of these ways:

Push the CANCEL button on thesteering wheel.

Press the Cruise Control MasterSwitch.

CONTINUED

Cancelling the Cruise Control

Cruise Control

Comfort and Convenience Features 161

CCAANNCCEELLBBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:10:56 31S5A610_164

Page 165: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When you push the CANCEL button,or tap the brake or clutch pedal, theCRUISE CONTROL light on theinstrument panel will go out and thecar will begin to slow down. You canuse the accelerator pedal in thenormal way.

The system remembers thepreviously-set cruising speed. Toreturn to that speed, accelerate toabove 25 mph (40 km/h), then pressthe RESUME/accel button. TheCRUISE CONTROL light comes on,and the car will accelerate to thesame cruising speed as before.

Pressing the Cruise Control MasterSwitch turns the system completelyoff and erases the previous cruisingspeed from memory. To use thesystem again, refer to

.

Cruise Control

Comfort and Convenience Features

Using theCruise Control

162

01/06/02 17:11:02 31S5A610_165

Page 166: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Before you begin driving your Honda,you should know what gasoline touse, and how to check the levels ofimportant fluids. You also need toknow how to properly store luggageor packages. The information in thissection will help you. If you plan toadd any accessories to your car,please read the information in thissection first.

.............................Break-in Period . 164.........................................Gasoline . 164

.........Service Station Procedures . 165................Filling the Fuel Tank . 165

....................Opening the Hood . 166...............................Oil Check . 168

.........Engine Coolant Check . 169...............................Fuel Economy . 170

.....................Vehicle Condition . 170...........................Driving Habits . 170

...Accessories and Modifications . 171.............................Carrying Cargo . 173

Before Driving

Before Driving 163

01/06/02 17:11:07 31S5A610_166

Page 167: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

During this period:

Avoid full-throttle starts and rapidacceleration.

Avoid hard braking. New brakesneed to be broken-in by moderateuse for the first 200 miles (300km).

Your Honda is designed to operateon unleaded gasoline with a pumpoctane number of 86 or higher. Useof a lower octane gasoline can causea persistent, heavy metallic rappingnoise in the engine that can lead tomechanical damage.

We recommend gasolines containingdetergent additives that help preventfuel system and engine deposits.

In Canada, some gasolines containan octane-enhancing additive calledMMT. If you use such gasolines,your emission control systemperformance may deteriorate andthe Malfunction Indicator Lamp onyour instrument panel may turn on.If this happens, contact yourauthorized Honda dealer for service.

Help assure your car’s futurereliability and performance by payingextra attention to how you driveduring the first 600 miles (1,000 km).

Using gasoline containing lead willdamage your car’s emissionscontrols. This contributes to airpollution.

You should follow these same re-commendations with an overhauledor exchanged engine, or when thebrakes are relined.

Do not change the oil until therecommended time or mileageinterval shown in the maintenanceschedule.

Break-in Period, Gasoline

Before Driving

Break-in Period Gasoline

164

01/06/02 17:11:18 31S5A610_167

Page 168: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Remove the fuel fill cap slowly.You may hear a hissing sound aspressure inside the tank escapes.

Because the fuel fill cap is on thedriver’s side of the car, park withthat side closest to the servicestation pumps.

Your car has an on-board refuelingvapor recovery system to helpkeep fuel vapors from going intothe atmosphere. If the fuel nozzlekeeps clicking off even though thetank is not full, there may be aproblem with this system. Consultyour dealer.

Stop filling the tank after the fuelnozzle automatically clicks off. Donot try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank, leavesome room for the fuel to expandwith temperature changes.

Open the fuel fill door by pushingon the handle to the left of thedriver’s seat.

1.

2.

3.

4.

CONTINUED

Filling the Fuel Tank

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving 165

FFUUEELL FFIILLLL CCAAPP

PPuusshh

Gasoline is highly flammableand explosive. You can beburned or seriously injuredwhen handling fuel.

Stop the engine and keepheat, sparks, and flame away.Handle fuel only outdoors.Wipe up spills immediately.

01/06/02 17:11:30 31S5A610_168

Page 169: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Shift to Park or Neutral and setthe parking brake. Pull the hoodrelease handle located under thelower left corner of the dashboard.The hood will pop up slightly.

Screw the fuel fill cap back on,tighten it until it clicks severaltimes. If you do not properlytighten the cap, the MalfunctionIndicator Lamp may come on (seepage ).

Push the fuel fill door closed untilit latches.

Standing in front of the car, putyour fingers between the frontedge of the hood and the frontgrille. The hood latch handle isabove the ‘‘H’’ logo. Push thishandle up until it releases thehood. Lift the hood.

1. 2.

5.

6.

281

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving

Opening the Hood

166

HHOOOODDRREELLEEAASSEEHHAANNDDLLEE

LLAATTCCHH

01/06/02 17:11:40 31S5A610_169

Page 170: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you can open the hood withoutlifting the hood latch handle, or thehood latch handle moves stiffly ordoes not spring back as before, themechanism should be cleaned andlubricated (see page ).

Pull the support rod out of its clipby holding the grip and insert theend into the hole on the front leftside of the hood.

To close the hood, lift it up slightly toremove the support rod from thehole. Put the support rod back intoits holding clip. Lower the hood toabout a foot (30 cm) above thefender, then let it drop.

After closing the hood, make sure itis securely latched.

3.

226

CONTINUED

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving 167

CCLLIIPPSSUUPPPPOORRTT RROODD

GGRRIIPP

01/06/02 17:11:47 31S5A610_170

Page 171: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Wipe the dipstick with a cleancloth or paper towel.

Insert it all the way back in its tube.

Remove the dipstick (orangehandle).

Check the engine oil level every timeyou fill the car with fuel. Wait a fewminutes after turning the engine offbefore you check the oil.

2. 3.

1.

Oil Check

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving168

DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK

01/06/02 17:11:57 31S5A610_171

Page 172: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Remove the dipstick again andcheck the level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.

Look at the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Make sure it isbetween the MAX and MIN lines. Ifit is below the MIN line, see

on page forinformation on adding the propercoolant.

If it is near or below the lower mark,see on page .

Refer toon page for information

on checking other items in yourHonda.

4.

209

213

207

AddingEngine Coolant

Adding Oil

Owner MaintenanceChecks

Engine Coolant Check

Service Station Procedures

Before Driving 169

LLOOWWEERR MMAARRKK

MMAAXX

UUPPPPEERR MMAARRKK

RREESSEERRVVEE TTAANNKK

MMIINN

01/06/02 17:12:07 31S5A610_172

Page 173: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

A cold engine uses more fuel than awarm engine. It is not necessary to‘‘warm-up’’ a cold engine by letting itidle for a long time. You can driveaway in about a minute, no matterhow cold it is outside. The enginewill warm up faster, and you getbetter fuel economy. To cut down onthe number of ‘‘cold starts,’’ try tocombine several short trips into one.

You can improve fuel economy bydriving moderately. Rapid acceler-ation, abrupt cornering, and hardbraking use more fuel.

Always drive in the highest gear thatallows the engine to run and acceler-ate smoothly.

The air conditioning puts an extraload on the engine which makes ituse more fuel. Turn off the A/C tocut down on air conditioning use.Use the flow-through ventilationwhen the outside air temperature ismoderate.

The condition of your car and yourdriving habits are the two mostimportant things that affect the fuelmileage you get.

Always maintain your car accordingto the maintenance schedule. Thiswill keep it in top operating condition.

Depending on traffic conditions, tryto maintain a constant speed. Everytime you slow down and speed up,your car uses extra fuel. Use thecruise control, when appropriate, toincrease fuel economy.

An important part of that mainte-nance is the

(see page ). Forexample, an underinflated tirecauses more ‘‘rolling resistance,’’which uses fuel. It also wears outfaster, so check the tire pressure atleast monthly.

In winter, the build-up of snow onyour car’s underside adds weight androlling resistance. Frequent cleaninghelps your fuel mileage and reducesthe chance of corrosion.

207

Vehicle Condition

Driving Habits

Owner MaintenanceChecks

Before Driving

Fuel Economy

170

01/06/02 17:12:20 31S5A610_173

Page 174: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Modifying your car, or installingsome non-Honda accessories, canmake your car unsafe. Before youmake any modifications or add anyaccessories, be sure to read thefollowing information.

When properly installed, cellularphones, alarms, two-way radios, andlow-powered audio systems shouldnot interfere with your car’scomputer-controlled systems, suchas the SRS and anti-lock brakesystem.

If possible, have your dealer inspectthe final installation.

Have the installer contact yourHonda dealer for assistance beforeinstalling any electronic accessory.

Be sure electronic accessories donot overload electrical circuits(see page ).

Make sure the accessory does notobscure any lights, or interferewith proper car operation orperformance.

Before installing any accessory:

However, if electronic accessoriesare improperly installed, or exceedyour car’s electrical system capacity,they can interfere with the operationof your car, or even cause theairbags to deploy.

Your dealer has Honda accessoriesthat allow you to personalize your car.These accessories have beendesigned and approved for your car,and are covered by warranty.

Non-Honda accessories are usuallydesigned for universal applications.Although aftermarket accessoriesmay fit on your car, they may notmeet factory specifications, andcould adversely affect your car’shandling and stability. (See‘‘Modifications’’ on page foradditional information.)

285

172

Accessories

Accessories and Modifications

Before Driving 171

Improper accessories ormodifications can affect yourcar’s handling, stability andperformance, and cause acrash in which you can be hurtor killed.

Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regardingaccessories and modifications.

01/06/02 17:12:33 31S5A610_174

Page 175: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

In addition, any modifications thatdecrease ground clearance increasethe chance of undercarriage partsstriking a curb, speed bump, or otherraised object, which could causeyour airbags to deploy.

Do not modify your steering wheelor any other part of yourSupplemental Restraint System.Modifications could make thesystem ineffective.

Do not remove any originalequipment or modify your car in anyway that would alter its design oroperation. This could make your carunsafe and illegal to drive.

For example, do not make anymodifications that would change theride height of your car, or installwheels and tires with a differentoverall diameter.

Such modifications can adverselyaffect handling, and interfere withthe operation of the car’s anti-lockbrakes and other systems.

If a side airbaginflates, a cup holder or other hardobject attached on or near thedoor could be propelled inside thecar and hurt someone.

Covering the outside edge of afront seat-back, with a non-Hondaseat cover for example, couldprevent the airbag from inflatingproperly.Any object

attached to or placed on the coversmarked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG,’’ in thecenter of the steering wheel andon top of the dashboard, couldinterfere with the proper operationof the airbags. Or, if the airbagsinflate, the objects could bepropelled inside the car and hurtsomeone.

Only on U.S. models equipped with sideairbags

Modifications

Additional Safety Precautions

Accessories and Modifications

Before Driving

Do not attach hard objects on ornear a front door.

Do not place any objects over theoutside edge of a front seat-back.

Do not attach or place objects onthe front airbag covers.

172

01/06/02 17:12:45 31S5A610_175

Page 176: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

****

**

**Your car has several convenientstorage areas so you can stow cargosafely.

However, carrying too much cargo,or improperly storing it, can affectyour car’s handling, stability, andoperation and make it unsafe. Beforecarrying any type of cargo, be sure toread the following pages.

The glove box, and the pockets inthe front doors and seat-back, aredesigned for small, lightweight items.The trunk is intended for larger,heavier items. In addition, the backseat can be folded down to allow youto carry more cargo or longer items.

Carrying Cargo

Before Driving 173

FFRROONNTT DDOOOORR PPOOCCKKEETT

GGLLOOVVEE BBOOXX

TTRRUUNNKK

11:: OOnn EEXX aanndd CCaannaaddiiaann LLXX mmooddeellss22:: OOnn EEXX aanndd LLXX mmooddeellss

SSEEAATT--BBAACCKK PPOOCCKKEETT

CCOONNSSOOLLEE CCOOMMPPAARRTTMMEENNTT

22

11

01/06/02 17:12:53 31S5A610_176

Page 177: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Store or secure all items that couldbe thrown around and hurtsomeone during a crash.

Be sure items placed on the floorbehind the front seats cannot rollunder the seats and interfere withthe driver’s ability to operate thepedals, or with the properoperation of the seats.

Keep the glove box closed whiledriving. If the lid is open, apassenger could injure their kneesduring a crash or sudden stop.

This figure includes the total weightof all occupants, cargo, andaccessories.

To figure out how much cargo youcan carry:

Add up the weight of all occupants.

The final number is the total weightof cargo you can carry.

The maximum load for your car is850 lbs (395 kg).

Subtract the total from 850 lbs(395 kg).

Do not put any items on top of thetrunk panel. They can block yourview and be thrown around the carduring a crash.

Carrying Items in the PassengerCompartment

Load Limit

Carrying Cargo

Before Driving174

Overloading or improperloading can affect handling andstability and cause a crash inwhich you can be hurt or killed.

Follow all load limits and otherloading guidelines in thismanual.

01/06/02 17:13:05 31S5A610_177

Page 178: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Distribute cargo evenly on thefloor of the trunk, placing theheaviest items on the bottom andas far forward as possible.

If you fold down the back seat, tiedown items that could be thrownabout the car during a crash orsudden stop.

If you can carry any items on aroof rack, be sure the total weightof the rack and the items does notexceed the maximum allowableweight. Please contact your Hondadealer for further information.

If you carry large items thatprevent you from closing the trunklid, exhaust gas can enter thepassenger area. To avoid thepossibility of carbon monoxidepoisoning, follow the instructionson page .54

Carrying Cargo in the Trunk or ona Roof Rack

Carrying Cargo

Before Driving 175

01/06/02 17:13:12 31S5A610_178

Page 179: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

176

01/06/02 17:13:14 31S5A610_179

Page 180: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This section gives you tips onstarting the engine under variousconditions, and how to operate the5-speed manual and automatictransmissions. It also includes impor-tant information on parking your car,and the braking system.

........................Preparing to Drive . 178.......................Starting the Engine . 179

Starting in Cold Weather....................at High Altitude . 179

....5-speed Manual Transmission . 180.....Recommended Shift Points . 181

..............Engine Speed Limiter . 181

..............Automatic Transmission . 182.Shift Lever Position Indicator . 182

................Shift Lever Positions . 183..............Engine Speed Limiter . 185

....................Shift Lock Release . 186...........................................Parking . 187

..............................Parking Tips . 187.....................The Braking System . 188

.............Brake Wear Indicators . 188...............Brake System Design . 189

.......................Anti-lock Brakes . 189Important Safety

.........................Reminders . 190........................ABS Indicator . 191

...............Driving in Bad Weather . 192...........................Towing a Trailer . 193

Driving

Driving 177

01/06/02 17:13:20 31S5A610_180

Page 181: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Make sure all windows, mirrors,and outside lights are clean andunobstructed. Remove frost, snow,or ice.

Check that the hood and trunk arefully closed.

Make sure the doors are securelyclosed and locked.

Check that any items you may becarrying with you inside are storedproperly or fastened downsecurely.

Visually check the tires. If a tirelooks low, use a gauge to check itspressure.

Check the adjustment of the seat(see page ).

Check the adjustment of theinside and outside mirrors (seepage ).

Check the adjustment of thesteering wheel (see page ).

Turn the ignition switch ON (II).Check the indicator lights in theinstrument panel.

Start the engine (see page ).

Check the gauges and indicatorlights in the instrument panel (seepage ).

Fasten your seat belt. Check thatyour passengers have fastenedtheir seat belts (see page ).

You should do the following checksand adjustments every day beforeyou drive your car.

1.

2.

3.

4. 9.

10.

8.

7.

6.

5.

11.

12.

16

59

88

96

76

179

Preparing to Drive

Driving178

01/06/02 17:13:33 31S5A610_181

Page 182: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If the engine does not start within15 seconds, or starts but stallsright away, repeat step 4 with theaccelerator pedal pressed half-waydown. If the engine starts, releasepressure on the accelerator pedalso the engine does not race.

If the engine still does not start,press the accelerator pedal all theway down and hold it there whilestarting in order to clear flooding.As before, keep the ignition key inthe START (III) position for nomore than 15 seconds. Return tostep 5 if the engine does not start.If it starts, lift your foot off theaccelerator pedal so the enginedoes not race.

Apply the parking brake.

In cold weather, turn off allelectrical accessories to reducethe drain on the battery.

Push the clutch pedal down all theway. START (III) does notfunction unless the clutch pedal isdepressed.

Make sure the shift lever is inPark. Press on the brake pedal.

Without touching the acceleratorpedal, turn the ignition key to theSTART (III) position. If the enginedoes not start right away, do nothold the key in START (III) formore than 15 seconds at a time.Pause for at least 10 secondsbefore trying again. An engine is harder to start in cold

weather. The thinner air found athigh altitude above 8,000 feet (2,400

meters) adds to the problem.Use the following procedure:

Turn off all electrical accessoriesto reduce the drain on the battery.

Push the accelerator pedal half-way to the floor and hold it therewhile starting the engine. Do nothold the ignition key in START(III) for more than 15 seconds.When the engine starts, releasethe accelerator pedal gradually asthe engine speeds up and smoothsout.

If the engine fails to start in step 2,push the accelerator pedal to thefloor and hold it there while youtry to start the engine for no morethan 15 seconds. If the enginedoes not start, return to step 2.

1.

2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

1.

2.

3.

Manual Transmission:

Automatic Transmission:

Starting the Engine

Driving

Starting in Cold Weather at HighAltitude (Above 8,000 feet/2,400 meters)

179

01/06/02 17:13:49 31S5A610_182

Page 183: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The manual transmission is syn-chronized in all forward gears forsmooth operation. It has a lockout soyou cannot shift directly from Fifthto Reverse. When shifting up ordown, make sure you push the clutchpedal down all the way, shift to thenext gear, and let the pedal upgradually. When you are not shifting,do not rest your foot on the clutchpedal. This can cause your clutch towear out faster.

Come to a full stop before you shiftinto Reverse. You can damage thetransmission by trying to shift intoReverse with the car moving. Pushdown the clutch pedal, and pause fora few seconds before shifting intoReverse, or shift into one of theforward gears for a moment. Thisstops the gears so they won’t ‘‘grind.’’

When slowing down, you can getextra braking from the engine byshifting to a lower gear. This extrabraking can help you maintain a safespeed and prevent your brakes fromoverheating while going down asteep hill. Before downshifting,make sure the vehicle speed is lowenough that you will not activate theengine speed limiter in the lowergear. On EX and LX models, makesure the engine speed will not go intothe tachometer’s red zone in thelower gear before downshifting.

5-speed Manual Transmission

Driving180

Rapid slowing or speeding-upcan cause loss of control onslippery surfaces. If you crash,you can be injured.

Use extra care when driving onslippery surfaces.

01/06/02 17:13:57 31S5A610_183

Page 184: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Drive in the highest gear that letsthe engine run and acceleratesmoothly. This will give you the bestfuel economy and effective emis-sions control. The following shiftpoints are recommended:

If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, the enginespeed will enter into the tachometer’sred zone. If this occurs, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce theRPM below the red zone.

Before downshifting, make sure theengine will not go into thetachometer’s red zone.

Shift up

1st to 2nd2nd to 3rd3rd to 4th4th to 5th

Normal acceleration

15 mph (24 km/h)27 mph (43 km/h)39 mph (63 km/h)53 mph (85 km/h)

Shift up

1st to 2nd2nd to 3rd3rd to 4th4th to 5th

9 mph (14 km/h)20 mph (32 km/h)33 mph (53 km/h)48 mph (77 km/h)

If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce theengine speed by upshifting orslowing down.

Before downshifting, make sure thevehicle speed is low enough that youwill not activate the engine speedlimiter in the lower gear.

Cruise from acceleration

On EX and LX modelsOn DX model

5-speed Manual Transmission

Driving

Recommended Shift Points Engine Speed Limiter

181

01/06/02 17:14:09 31S5A610_184

Page 185: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your Honda’s transmission has fourforward speeds, and is electronicallycontrolled for smoother shifting. Italso has a ‘‘lock-up’’ torque converterfor better fuel economy. You mayfeel what seems like another shiftwhen the converter locks.

This indicator on the instrumentpanel shows which position the shiftlever is in.

The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II). If it flasheswhile driving (in any shift position),it indicates a possible problem in thetransmission. Avoid rapid acceler-ation and have the transmissionchecked by an authorized Hondadealer as soon as possible.

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Shift Lever Position Indicator

182

EEXX aanndd LLXX DDXX

01/06/02 17:14:18 31S5A610_185

Page 186: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Do this:Press the brake pedal andpress the release button.

Press the release button.

Move the lever.

3

To shift from:P to R

R to PN to RD to 22 to DD to DD to ND to DN to DR to N

This position mechani-cally locks the transmission. UsePark whenever you are turning off orstarting the engine. To shift out ofPark, you must press on the brakepedal and have your foot off theaccelerator pedal. Press the releasebutton on the front of the shift leverto move it.

The shift lever has six positions. Itmust be in Park or Neutral to startthe engine. When you are stopped inD, D , 2, N or R, press firmly on thebrake pedal, and keep your foot offthe accelerator pedal.

3

3

3

3

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Shift Lever Positions

Park (P)

183

SSHHIIFFTT LLEEVVEERR

RREELLEEAASSEE BBUUTTTTOONN

01/06/02 17:14:27 31S5A610_186

Page 187: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

-If you have done all of the above andstill cannot move the lever out ofPark, see Shift Lock Release on page

.

You must also press the releasebutton to shift into Park. To avoidtransmission damage, come to acomplete stop before shifting intoPark. The shift lever must be in Parkbefore you can remove the key fromthe ignition switch.

To shift to Reversefrom Park, see the explanation underPark. To shift to Reverse fromNeutral, come to a complete stop andthen shift. Press the release buttonbefore shifting into Reverse fromNeutral.

Use Neutral if youneed to restart a stalled engine, or ifit is necessary to stop briefly withthe engine idling. Shift to Park posi-tion if you need to leave the car forany reason. Press on the brake pedalwhen you are moving the shift leverfrom Neutral to another gear.

Use this position foryour normal driving. The transmis-sion automatically selects a suitablegear for your speed and acceleration.You may notice the transmissionshifting up at higher speeds whenthe engine is cold. This helps theengine warm up faster.

186

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Reverse (R)

Neutral (N)

Drive (D)

184

01/06/02 17:14:34 31S5A610_187

Page 188: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

--

If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, the enginespeed will enter into the tachometer’sred zone. If this occurs, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce theRPM below the red zone.

To shift to Second,press the release button on the frontof the shift lever. This position locksthe transmission in second gear. Itdoes not downshift to first gearwhen you come to a stop. Secondgives you more power when climbing,and increased engine braking whengoing down steep hills. Use secondgear when starting out on a slipperysurface or in deep snow. It will helpreduce wheelspin.

If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce theengine speed by upshifting orslowing down.

This position is similarto D, except only the first threegears are selected. Use D to provideengine braking when going down asteep hill. D can also keep thetransmission from cycling betweenthird and fourth gears in stop-and-godriving.

For faster acceleration when in D orD, you can get the transmission toautomatically downshift by pushingthe accelerator pedal to the floor.The transmission will shift down oneor two gears, depending on yourspeed.

3

3

3

On EX and LX models

On DX model

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Engine Speed LimiterSecond (2)Drive (D )3

185

01/06/02 17:14:43 31S5A610_188

Page 189: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This allows you to move the shiftlever out of Park if the normalmethod of pushing on the brakepedal and pressing the releasebutton does not work.

Set the Parking brake.

Remove the key from the ignitionswitch.

Push down on the key while youpress the release button on theshift lever and move the shift leverout of Park to Neutral.

Insert the key in the Shift LockRelease slot.

Put a cloth on the edge of the ShiftLock Release slot cover next tothe shift lever.Use a small flat-tipped screwdriveror small metal plate (neither areincluded in the tool kit) to removethe cover. Carefully pry off theedge of the cover.

Remove the key from the ShiftLock Release slot, then reinstallthe cover. Make sure the notch onthe cover is on the left side.Return the key to the ignitionswitch, depress the brake pedal,and restart the engine.

If you need to use the Shift LockRelease, it means your car isdeveloping a problem. Have the carchecked by your Honda dealer.

1.

2.

3.4.

5.

6.

Automatic Transmission

Driving

Shift Lock Release

186

RREELLEEAASSEE BBUUTTTTOONN

SSHHIIFFTT LLOOCCKKRREELLEEAASSEE SSLLOOTTCCOOVVEERR

01/06/02 17:14:57 31S5A610_189

Page 190: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Make sure the moonroof and thewindows are closed.

Make sure the parking brake is fullyreleased before driving away.Driving with the parking brakepartially set can overheat or damagethe rear brakes.

Turn off the lights.

Place any packages, valuables, etc.,in the trunk or take them with you.

Lock the doors with the key or theremote transmitter.

Never park over dry leaves, tallgrass, or other flammablematerials. The three way catalyticconverter gets very hot, and couldcause these materials to catch onfire.

Always use the parking brake whenyou park your car. The indicator onthe instrument panel shows that theparking brake is not fully released; itdoes not indicate that the parkingbrake is firmly set. Make sure theparking brake is set firmly or yourcar may roll if it is parked on anincline.

If your car has an automatictransmission, set the parking brakebefore you put the transmission inPark. This keeps the car frommoving and putting pressure on theparking mechanism in thetransmission making it easier tomove the shift lever out of Parkwhen you want to drive away.

If the car is facing uphill, turn thefront wheels away from the curb. Ifyou have a manual transmission, putit in first gear.

If the car is facing downhill, turn thefront wheels toward the curb. If youhave a manual transmission, put it inreverse gear.

Parking

Parking Tips

Driving 187

01/06/02 17:15:08 31S5A610_190

Page 191: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Check your brakes after drivingthrough deep water. Apply thebrakes moderately to see if they feelnormal. If not, apply them gently andfrequently until they do. Since alonger distance is needed to stopwith wet brakes, be extra cautiousand alert in your driving.

Constant application of the brakeswhen going down a long hill buildsup heat and reduces their effective-ness. Use the engine to assist thebrakes by downshifting to a lowergear and taking your foot off theaccelerator pedal.

When the brake pads need replacing,you will hear a distinctive metallic‘‘screeching’’ sound when you applythe brakes. If you do not have thebrake pads replaced, they will beginscreeching all the time.

Your brakes may sometimes squealor squeak when you apply themlightly. Do not confuse this with thebrake wear indicators. They make avery audible ‘‘screeching.’’

The front disc brakes on all modelshave audible brake wear indicators.

All Civics are equipped with frontdisc brakes. The brakes on the rearwheels are drum. A power assisthelps reduce the effort needed onthe brake pedal. The ABS (on carsequipped with ABS) helps you retainsteering control when braking veryhard.

Put your foot on the brake pedal onlywhen you intend to brake. Restingyour foot on the pedal keeps thebrakes applied lightly, causing themto build up heat. Heat build-up canreduce how well your brakes work. Italso keeps your brake lights on allthe time, confusing drivers behindyou.

Brake Wear Indicators

The Braking System

Driving188

01/06/02 17:15:17 31S5A610_191

Page 192: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

The hydraulic system that operatesthe brakes has two separate circuits.Each circuit works diagonally acrossthe vehicle (the left-front brake isconnected with the right-rear brake,etc.). If one circuit should develop aproblem, you will still have brakingat two wheels.

this defeats thepurpose of the ABS. Let the ABSwork for you by always keeping firm,steady pressure on the brake pedalas you steer away from the hazard.This is sometimes referred to as

You will feel a pulsation in the brakepedal when the ABS activates, andyou may hear some noise. This isnormal, it is the ABS rapidlypumping the brakes.

The U.S. EX and Canadian LXmodels have an Anti-lock BrakeSystem (ABS) as standardequipment.It is optional on the U.S. LX model.

ABS helps to prevent the wheelsfrom locking up and skidding duringhard braking, allowing you to retainsteering control.

When the front tires skid, you losesteering control; the car continuesstraight ahead even though you turnthe steering wheel. The ABS helps toprevent lock-up and helps you retainsteering control by pumping thebrakes rapidly; much faster than aperson can do it.

‘‘stomp and steer.’’

Brake System Design Anti-lock Brakes You should never pump thebrake pedal,

Driving

The Braking System

189

FFrroonntt

01/06/02 17:15:29 31S5A610_192

Page 193: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

on loose oruneven surfaces, such as gravel orsnow, than a vehicle without anti-lock. Slow down and allow a greaterdistance between vehicles underthose conditions.

itonly helps with steering controlduring braking. You should alwaysmaintain a safe following distancefrom other vehicles.

such as trying to take acorner too fast or making a suddenlane change. Always drive at a safe,prudent speed for the road andweather conditions.

Always steer moderatelywhen you are braking hard. Severeor sharp steering wheel movementcan still cause your car to veer intooncoming traffic or off the road.

Activation varies with the amount oftraction your tires have. On drypavement, you will need to press onthe brake pedal very hard before youactivate the ABS. However, you mayfeel the ABS activate immediately ifyou are trying to stop on snow or ice.

The Braking System

Driving

A vehicle with ABS may require alonger distance to stopABS does not reduce the time or

distance it takes to stop the car,

ABS will not prevent a skid thatresults from changing directionabruptly,

ABS cannot prevent a loss ofstability.

Important Safety Reminders

190

01/06/02 17:15:37 31S5A610_193

Page 194: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

**

**

The ABS is self-checking. If anythinggoes wrong, the ABS indicator onthe instrument panel comes on (seepage ). This means the anti-lockfunction of the braking system hasshut down. The brakes still work likea conventional system without anti-lock, providing normal stoppingability. You should have the dealerinspect your car as soon as possible.

62

The Braking System

Driving

ABS Indicator

191

UU..SS.. iinnddiiccaattoorr sshhoowwnn

AABBSS IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:15:43 31S5A610_194

Page 195: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

-- Being able to seeclearly in all directions and beingvisible to other drivers are importantin all weather conditions. This ismore difficult in bad weather. To beseen more clearly during daylighthours, turn on your headlights.

Inspect your windshield wipers andwashers frequently. Keep the wind-shield washer reservoir full of theproper fluid. Have the windshieldwiper blades replaced if they start tostreak the windshield or leave partsunwiped. Use the defrosters and airconditioning to keep the windowsfrom fogging up on the inside (seepage ).

Exercise extra caution when drivingin rain after a long dry spell. Aftermonths of dry weather, the firstrains bring oil to the surface of theroadway, making it slippery.

Rain, fog, and snow conditionsrequire a different driving techniquebecause of reduced traction andvisibility. Keep your car well-maintained and exercise greatercaution when you need to drive inbad weather. The cruise controlshould not be used in theseconditions.

Always driveslower than you would in dryweather. It takes your car longer toreact, even in conditions that mayseem just barely damp. Applysmooth, even pressure to all thecontrols. Abrupt steering wheelmovements or sudden, hard appli-cation of the brakes can cause loss ofcontrol in wet weather. Be extracautious for the first few miles(kilometers) of driving while youadjust to the change in drivingconditions. This is especially true insnow. A person can forget somesnow-driving techniques during thesummer months. Practice is neededto relearn those skills. 111

Driving in Bad Weather

Driving

VisibilityDriving Technique

192

01/06/02 17:15:51 31S5A610_195

Page 196: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- Check your tiresfrequently for wear and properpressure. Both are important inpreventing ‘‘hydroplaning’’ (loss oftraction on a wet surface). In thewinter, mount snow tires on all fourwheels for the best handling.

Watch road conditions carefully,they can change from moment tomoment. Wet leaves can be as slip-pery as ice. ‘‘Clear’’ roads can havepatches of ice. Driving conditionscan be very hazardous when theoutside temperature is near freezing.The road surface can becomecovered with areas of water puddlesmixed with areas of ice, so yourtraction can change without warning.

Be careful when downshifting. Iftraction is low, you can lock up thedrive wheels for a moment and causea skid.

Be very cautious when passing, orbeing passed by other vehicles. Thespray from large vehicles reducesyour visibility, and the wind buffetingcan cause you to lose control.

Your vehicle is not designed to tow atrailer. Attempting to do so can voidyour warranties.

Driving in Bad Weather, Towing a Trailer

Driving

Towing a TrailerTraction

193

01/06/02 17:16:00 31S5A610_196

Page 197: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

194

01/06/02 17:16:03 31S5A610_197

Page 198: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This section also includesMaintenance Schedules for normaldriving and severe driving conditions,a Maintenance Record, and instruc-tions for simple maintenance tasksyou may want to take care ofyourself.

If you have the skills and tools to per-form more complex maintenancetasks on your Honda, you may wantto purchase the Service Manual. Seepage for information on how toobtain a copy, or see your Hondadealer.

This section explains why it isimportant to keep your car wellmaintained and to follow basicmaintenance safety precautions.

......................Maintenance Safety . 196.Important Safety Precautions . 197

.................Maintenance Schedule . 198

...Required Maintenance Record . 205.......Owner Maintenance Checks . 207

..............................Fluid Locations . 208......................................Engine Oil . 209

..................................Adding Oil . 209....................Recommended Oil . 209

..............................Synthetic Oil . 210....................................Additives . 210

.....Changing the Oil and Filter . 211.............................Cooling System . 213

............Adding Engine Coolant . 213.......Replacing Engine Coolant . 215

....................Windshield Washers . 219.......................Transmission Fluid . 220

Automatic.........................Transmission . 220

5-speed Manual.........................Transmission . 221

................Brake and Clutch Fluid . 222............................Brake System . 222...........................Clutch System . 223

..............................Power Steering . 224.....................Air Cleaner Element . 225

....................................Hood Latch . 226

....................................Spark Plugs . 227..............................Replacement . 227

............................Specifications . 229...........................................Battery . 230

.................................Wiper Blades . 232..............Air Conditioning System . 234

..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 235.....................................Drive Belts . 237....................................Timing Belt . 237

...............................................Tires . 238......................................Inflation . 238

Recommended Tire Pressures...........for Normal Driving . 239

Tire Pressure Adjustment for..........High Speed Driving . 239

..................................Inspection . 240..............................Maintenance . 240.............................Tire Rotation . 241

...Replacing Tires and Wheels . 242......................Wheels and Tires . 243

..........................Winter Driving . 243.............................Snow Tires . 243............................Tire Chains . 244

.............................................Lights . 245.....................Headlight Aiming . 247

........................Replacing Bulbs . 247...........................Storing Your Car . 256

311

Maintenance

Maintenance 195

01/06/02 17:16:10 31S5A610_198

Page 199: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Some of the most important safetyprecautions are given here. However,we cannot warn you of everyconceivable hazard that can arise inperforming maintenance. Only youcan decide whether or not youshould perform a given task.

This section includes instructions forsimple maintenance tasks, such aschecking and adding oil. Any serviceitems not detailed in this sectionshould be performed by a Hondatechnician or other qualifiedmechanic.

Regularly maintaining your car is thebest way to protect your investment.Proper maintenance is essential toyour safety and the safety of yourpassengers. It will also reward youwith more economical, trouble-freedriving and help reduce air pollution.

Maintenance

Maintenance Safety

196

Failure to properly followmaintenance instructions andprecautions can cause you tobe seriously hurt or killed.

Always follow the proceduresand precautions in this owner’smanual.

Improperly maintaining this caror failing to correct a problembefore driving can cause acrash in which you can beseriously hurt or killed.

Always follow the inspectionand maintenancerecommendations andschedules in this owner’smanual.

01/06/02 17:16:17 31S5A610_199

Page 200: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Be surethere is adequate ventilationwhenever you operate the engine.

Let theengine and exhaust system coolbefore touching any parts.

Donot run the engine unless in-structed to do so.

Read the instructions before youbegin, and make sure you have thetools and skills required.

Before you begin any maintenance,make sure your car is parked onlevel ground and that the parkingbrake is set. Also, be sure the engineis off. This will help to eliminateseveral potential hazards:

You should wear eye protection andprotective clothing when workingnear the battery or when usingcompressed air.

To reduce the possibility of fire orexplosion, be careful when workingaround gasoline or batteries. Use acommercially available degreaser orparts cleaner, not gasoline, to cleanparts. Keep cigarettes, sparks, andflames away from the battery and allfuel-related parts.

Maintenance Safety

Maintenance

Important Safety Precautions

Carbon monoxide poisoningfrom engine exhaust.

Burns from hot parts.

Injury from moving parts.

197

01/06/02 17:16:26 31S5A610_200

Page 201: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The Maintenance Schedule specifieshow often you should have your carserviced and what things needattention. It is essential that you haveyour car serviced as scheduled toretain its high level of safety,dependability, and emissions controlperformance.

Avoid exceeding your car’s loadlimit. This puts excess stress onthe engine, brakes, and manyother parts of your car. The loadlimit is shown on the label on thedriver’s doorjamb.

Operate your car on reasonableroads within the legal speed limit.

Drive your car regularly over adistance of several miles(kilometers).

Always use unleaded gasoline withthe proper octane rating (see page

).

The services and time or distanceintervals shown in the maintenanceschedule assume you will use yourcar as normal transportation forpassengers and their possessions.You should also follow theserecommendations:

Service your car according to thetime and mileage periods on one ofthe Maintenance Schedules on thefollowing pages.

Follow theMaintenance Schedule for SevereConditions if you drive your carMAINLY under one or more of thefollowing conditions.

Driving less than 5 miles (8 km)per trip or, in freezingtemperatures, driving less than 10miles (16 km) per trip.

Driving in extremely hot [over90°F (32°C)] conditions.

Extensive idling or long periods ofstop-and-go driving.

Driving with a roof rack, or drivingin mountainous conditions.164

Maintenance Schedule

Maintenance

Which Schedule to Follow:

U.S. Owners

198

01/06/02 17:16:39 31S5A610_201

Page 202: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

According to state and federalregulations, failure to performmaintenance on the items markedwith will not void your emissionswarranties. However, Hondarecommends that all maintenanceservices be performed at therecommended time or mileageperiod to ensure long-term reliability.

Driving on muddy, dusty, or de-iced roads.

NOTE: If you only OCCASIONALLYor NEVER, drive under a ‘‘severe’’condition, you should follow theMaintenance Schedule for NormalConditions.

Your authorized Honda dealerknows your car best and can providecompetent, efficient service.However, service at a dealer is notmandatory to keep your warrantiesin effect. Maintenance may be doneby any qualified service facility orperson who is skilled in this type ofautomotive service. Keep all thereceipts as proof of completion, andhave the person who does the workfill out the Maintenance Record.Check your warranty booklet for

more information.

U.S. Vehicles:

We recommend the use of genuineHonda parts and fluids whenever youhave maintenance done. These aremanufactured to the same high-quality standards as the originalcomponents, so you can be confidentof their performance and durability.

Follow theMaintenance Schedule for SevereConditions.

Maintenance

Maintenance Schedule

Maintenance, replacement orrepair of emissions controldevices and systems may be doneby any automotive repairestablishment or individual usingparts that are ‘‘certif ied’’ to EPAstandards.

Canadian Owners

199

01/06/02 17:16:48 31S5A610_202

Page 203: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

**#

Maintenance200

Service at the indicated distance or time whichever comes first. miles x 1,000km x 1,000months

1016

5080

70112

110176

Check oil and coolant at each fuel stopCheck engine oil and coolantReplace engine oilRotate tires (Check tire inflation and condition at least once per month)Replace engine oil filterInspect front and rear brakesCheck parking brake adjustmentVisually inspect the following items:

Tie rod ends, steering gear box and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsBrake hoses and lines (including ABS)All fluid levels and condition of fluidsExhaust systemFuel lines and connections

Inspect and adjust drive beltsReplace dust and pollen filterReplace transmission fluid

Replace air cleaner elementReplace spark plugsInspect valve clearanceReplace timing belt, and inspect water pumpInspect idle speedReplace engine coolant

Replace brake fluid

Replace at 120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 6 years, then every 90,000 miles (144,000 km) or 5 years.See Dust and Pollen Filter on page for replacement information under special driving conditions.

See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, last column, page .

Service the following items at the recommended intervals

Every 3 years (independent of mileage)

At 120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years,then every 60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 5 years

Every 110,000 miles (176,000 km) or 7 yearsInspect every 110,000 miles (176,000 km), otherwise adjust only if noisy

Every 110,000 miles (176,000 km)Every 30,000 miles (48,000 km)

2032

3048

4064

6096

80128

90144

100160

120192

24 48 7212 36 60

1:2::

235

199

M/TA/T

1

2

Main

tenance

Sch

edule

for

Norm

alC

onditi

ons

01/06/02 17:17:11 31S5A610_203

Page 204: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

--

□□□□□□□□□□

□□□□□

□□

□□

□□

Maintenance 201

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

A, B, C, D, E

A

B

C

D

E

Refer to page to determine which schedule to use.Use the Maintenance Schedule for Severe Conditions.

Service at the indicated distance or time, whichever comes first.Service at the indicated distance or time, whichever comes first. Do the items in as required for each distance/time.

10,000 mi/16,000 km/1 yr20,000 mi/32,000 km/1 yr30,000 mi/48,000 km30,000 mi/48,000 km/2 yrs40,000 mi/64,000 km/2 yrs3 yrs50,000 mi/80,000 km/3 yrs60,000 mi/96,000 km60,000 mi/96,000 km/3 yrs70,000 mi/112,000 km/4 yrs80,000 mi/128,000 km/4 yrs90,000 mi/144,000 km90,000 mi/144,000 km/5 yrs100,000 mi/160,000 km/5 yrs110,000 mi/176,000 km

6 yrs110,000 mi/176,000 km/6 yrs110,000 mi/176,000 km/7 yrs

120,000 mi/192,000 km120,000 mi/192,000 km/6 yrs

120,000 mi/192,000 km/10 yrs

Replace engine oil.Rotate tires (follow pattern on page 241 ).Replace engine oil filter.Inspect front and rear brakes.Check parking brake adjustment.Inspect tie rod ends, steering gear box and boots.Inspect suspension components.Inspect driveshaft boots.Inspect brake hoses and lines (including ABS).Check all fluid levels, condition of fluids, and checkfor leaks.Inspect exhaust system.Inspect fuel lines and connections.

Inspect and adjust drive belts.Replace dust and pollen filter .Replace air cleaner element every 30,000 mi/48,000km (independent of time).Replace brake fluid every 3 years (independent ofmileage).

Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do item in D.Do items in A, C.Do items in A, B.Do item in E.Do items in A.Do item in D.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do item in D.Do items in A, C.Do items in A, B.

Inspect valve clearance, cold engine.Replace spark plugs.

Do item in E.Do items in A.

Replace timing belt, and inspect water pump.Inspect idle speed.

Do item in D.Replace transmission fluid (M/T).Replace transmission fluid (A/T), then

replace every 90,000 mi/144,000 km/5 yrs.Do items in A, B, C.

Replace engine coolant, then replace every60,000mi/96,000km/5yrs.

198

1

See Dust and Pollen Filter on page for replacementinformation under special driving conditions.See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, lastcolumn, page .

Check engine oil and coolant at each fuel stop.Check and adjust valve clearance, cold engine, only if noisy.

NOTE:

1:

:

235

199

Main

tenance

Sch

edule

for

Norm

alC

onditio

ns

(listed

by

dista

nce

/time)

01/06/02 17:17:23 31S5A610_204

Page 205: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

**#

# #

# *

Maintenance202

Service at the indicated distance or time whichever comes first. miles x 1,000km x 1,000months

Replace every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or 6 monthsCheck oil and coolant at each fuel stop

1016

5080

70112

110176

Check engine oil and coolantReplace engine oilRotate tires (Check tire inflation and condition at least once per month)Replace engine oil filterInspect front and rear brakesLubricate all hinges, locks, and latchesVisually inspect the following items:

Tie rod ends, steering gear box and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft boots

Check parking brake adjustmentVisually inspect the following items:

Brake hoses and lines (including ABS)All fluid levels and condition of fluidsExhaust system, Fuel lines and connections

Lights and controls, Vehicle underbodyInspect and adjust drive beltsReplace dust and pollen filterReplace transmission fluid

Replace air cleaner element

Replace spark plugsInspect valve clearanceReplace timing belt , and inspect water pump

Inspect idle speedReplace engine coolant

Replace brake fluid

See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, last column, page .See Timing Belt on page for replacement information under special driving conditions.See Dust and Pollen Filter on page for replacement information under special driving conditions.

At 120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years,then every 60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 5 years

Every 3 years (independent of mileage)

Every 110,000 miles (176,000 km) or 7 yearsInspect every 110,000 miles (176,000 km), otherwise adjust only if noisy

Every 110,000 miles (176,000 km)

Every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) in dusty conditions,otherwise use normal schedule

Service the following items at the recommended intervals

At 60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000 miles(48,000 km) or 2 years

2032

3048

4064

6096

80128

90144

100160

120192

24 48 7212 36 60

1:2::

235237

199

M/TA/T

1

2

Main

tenance

Sch

edule

for

Seve

reC

onditi

ons

01/06/02 17:17:49 31S5A610_205

Page 206: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

--

□□□□□

□□□□□□

□□□□□□□

□□

CONTINUEDMaintenance 203

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

A, B, C, D, E, F

A

B

C

D

E

F

Refer to page to determine which schedule to use.Use the Maintenance Schedule for Severe Conditions.

Service at the indicated distance or time, whichever comes first.Service at the indicated distance or time, whichever comes first. Do the items in as required for each distance/time.

5,000 mi/8,000 km10,000 mi/16,000 km/1 yr15,000 mi/24,000 km20,000 mi/32,000 km/1 yr25,000 mi/40,000 km30,000 mi/48,000 km30,000 mi/48,000 km/2 yrs35,000 mi/56,000 km40,000 mi/64,000 km/2 yrs45,000 mi/72,000 km3ys50,000 mi/80,000 km/3 yrs55,000 mi/88,000 km60,000 mi/96,000 km60,000 mi/96,000 km/3 yrs

65,000 mi/104,000 km70,000 mi/112,000 km/4 yrs75,000 mi/120,000 km80,000 mi/128,000 km/4 yrs85,000 mi/136,000 km90,000 mi/144,000 km90,000 mi/144,000 km/5 yrs

Replace engine oil.Replace engine oil filter.Inspect front and rear brakes.Rotate tires (follow pattern on page 241 ).Lubricate all hinges, locks, and latches withmultipurpose grease.Inspect tie rod ends, steering gear box and boots.Inspect suspension components.Inspect driveshaft boots.Check parking brake adjustment.Inspect brake hoses and lines (including ABS).Check all fluid levels, condition of fluids, and checkfor leaks.Inspect exhaust system.Inspect fuel lines and connections.

Check all lights.Inspect the underbody.Inspect and adjust drive belts.Replace dust and pollen filter .Replace air cleaner element every 15,000 mi/24,000 km (independent of time).Replace brake fluid every 3 years (independent ofmileage).

Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A, E.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A.Do item in E.Do items in A, B, D.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A, E.Do item in F.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do item in E.

Replace transmission fluid (M/T).Replace transmission fluid (A/T), thenreplace every 30,000 mi/48,000 km/2 yrs.

Do items in A, B, C, D.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A, E.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A.Do item in E.

Replace transmission fluid (A/T).Do items in A, B, D.

198

1

Main

tenance

Sch

edule

for

Seve

reC

onditio

ns

(listed

by

dista

nce

/time)

01/06/02 17:17:58 31S5A610_206

Page 207: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

□□

□□□

# *

Maintenance204

See Dust and Pollen Filter on page for replacementinformation under special driving conditions.See Timing Belt on page for replacement information underspecial driving conditions.See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, lastcolumn, page .

Check engine oil and coolant at each fuel stop.Check and adjust valve clearance, cold engine, only if noisy.

NOTE:

1:

2:

:

235

237

199

95,000 mi/152,000 km100,000 mi/160,000 km/5 yrs105,000 mi/168,000 km6 yrs110,000 mi/176,000 km

110,000 mi/176,000 km/6 yrs110,000 mi/176,000 km/7 yrs

115,000 mi/184,000 km120,000 mi/192,000 km120,000 mi/192,000 km/6 yrs

120,000 mi/192,000 km/7 yrs9 yrs120,000 mi/192,000 km/10 yrs

Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C.Do items in A, E.Do item in F.

Inspect valve clearance, cold engine.Replace spark plugs.

Do items in A, B.Replace timing belt , and inspect water

pump.Inspect idle speed.

Do items in A.Do item in E.

Replace transmission fluid (M/T).Do items in A, B, C, D.

Replace transmission fluid (A/T).Do item in F.Replace engine coolant, then replace every

60,000mi/96,000km/5yrs.

2

Main

tenance

Sch

edule

for

Seve

reC

onditi

ons

(lis

ted

by

dis

tance

/tim

e)

01/06/02 17:18:07 31S5A610_207

Page 208: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUEDMaintenance

Required Maintenance Record (for Normal and Severe Schedules)

205

5,000 mi

10,000 mi

15,000 mi

20,000 mi

25,000 mi

30,000 mi

35,000 mi

40,000 mi

45,000 mi

50,000 mi

55,000 mi

60,000 mi

Signature or dealer stamp Signature or dealer stamp8,000 km

16,000 km

24,000 km

32,000 km(or 1 year)

40,000 km

48,000 km

56,000 km

64,000 km(or 2 years)

72,000 km

80,000 km

88,000 km

96,000 km(or 3 years)

You or the servicing dealer can record all completed maintenance here, whether you follow the schedule for normal conditions (page ) or severeconditions (page ). Keep the receipts for all work done on your car.

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

Date

Date

Date

Date

Date

Date Date

Date

Date

Date

Date

Date

202200

01/06/02 17:18:18 31S5A610_208

Page 209: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Maintenance

Required Maintenance Record (for Normal and Severe Schedules)

206

65,000 mi

70,000 mi

75,000 mi

80,000 mi

85,000 mi

90,000 mi

95,000 mi

100,000 mi

105,000 mi

110,000 mi

115,000 mi

120,000 mi

Signature or dealer stamp Signature or dealer stamp104,000 km

112,000 km

120,000 km

128,000 km(or 4 years)

136,000 km

144,000 km

152,000 km

160,000 km(or 5 years)

168,000 km

176,000 km

184,000 km

192,000 km(or 6 years)

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

mi/km

Date

Date

Date

Date

Date

Date Date

Date

Date

Date

Date

Date

01/06/02 17:18:27 31S5A610_209

Page 210: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Engine oil level Check everytime you fill the fuel tank. Seepage .

Engine coolant level Check theradiator reserve tank every timeyou fill the fuel tank. See page .

Windshield washer fluid Checkthe level in the reservoir monthly.If weather conditions cause you touse the washers frequently, checkthe reservoir each time you stopfor fuel. See page .

You should check the followingitems at the specified intervals. Ifyou are unsure of how to performany check, turn to the page given.

Lights Check the operation ofthe headlights, parking lights,taillights, high-mount brake light,turn signals, brake lights, andlicense plate lights monthly. Seepage .

Tires Check the tire pressuremonthly. Examine the tread forwear and foreign objects. See page

.

Automatic transmission Checkthe fluid level monthly. See page

.

Brakes Check the fluid levelmonthly. See page .

168

169

219

220

222

238

245

Owner Maintenance Checks

Maintenance 207

01/06/02 17:18:37 31S5A610_210

Page 211: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Fluid Locations

Maintenance208

AAUUTTOOMMAATTIICCTTRRAANNSSMMIISSSSIIOONNFFLLUUIIDD DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK((YYeellllooww lloooopp))

BBRRAAKKEE FFLLUUIIDD((GGrraayy ccaapp))

EENNGGIINNEE OOIILLFFIILLLL CCAAPP

WWAASSHHEERR FFLLUUIIDD((BBlluuee ccaapp))

EENNGGIINNEE OOIILL DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK((OOrraannggee lloooopp))

PPOOWWEERR SSTTEEEERRIINNGGFFLLUUIIDD ((RReedd ccaapp))

EENNGGIINNEECCOOOOLLAANNTTRREESSEERRVVOOIIRR

RRAADDIIAATTOORR CCAAPP

CCLLUUTTCCHH FFLLUUIIDD((MMaannuuaallTTrraannssmmiissssiioonn oonnllyy))((GGrraayy ccaapp))

01/06/02 17:18:42 31S5A610_211

Page 212: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To add oil, unscrew and remove theengine oil fill cap on top of the valvecover. Pour in the oil, and install theengine oil fill cap. Tighten it securely.Wait a few minutes and recheck theoil level. Do not fill above the uppermark; you could damage the engine.

Oil is a major contributor to yourengine’s performance and longevity.Always use a premium-grade 5W-20detergent oil displaying the APICertification Seal. This seal indicatesthe oil is energy conserving, and thatit meets the American PetroleumInstitute’s latest requirements.

Make sure the API Certification Sealsays ‘‘For Gasoline Engines.’’

Honda Motor Oil is the preferred5W-20 lubricant for your vehicle. It ishighly recommended that you useHonda Motor Oil in your vehicle foroptimum engine protection.

CONTINUED

Recommended OilAdding Oil

Engine Oil

Maintenance 209

EENNGGIINNEE OOIILLFFIILLLL CCAAPP

AAPPII CCEERRTTIIFFIICCAATTIIOONN SSEEAALL

01/06/02 17:18:53 31S5A610_212

Page 213: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

You may use a synthetic motor oil ifit meets the same requirementsgiven for a conventional motor oil: itdisplays the API Certification Seal,and it is the proper weight as shownon the chart. When using syntheticoil, you must follow the oil and filterchange intervals given in themaintenance schedule.

Your Honda does not require any oiladditives. Additives may adverselyaffect your engine’s or transmission’sperformance and durability.

5W-20 oil is formulated for year-round protection of your Honda, toimprove cold weather starting, andto help your engine use less fuel.

If 5W-20 oil is not available, a 5W-30oil may be used. However, it shouldbe replaced with 5W-20 at the nextoil change.

The oil’s viscosity or weight isprovided on the container’s label.Select the oil for your vehicleaccording to this chart.

Engine Oil

Maintenance

Synthetic Oil

Additives

210

AAmmbbiieenntt TTeemmppeerraattuurree

01/06/02 17:19:02 31S5A610_213

Page 214: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Remove the oil filter and let theremaining oil drain. A specialwrench (available from yourHonda dealer) is required toremove the filter.

Install a new oil filter according toinstructions that come with it.

Run the engine until it reachesnormal operating temperature,then shut it off.

Open the hood and remove theengine oil fill cap. Remove the oildrain bolt and washer from thebottom of the engine. Drain the oilinto an appropriate container.

Always change the oil and filteraccording to the time and distance(miles/kilometers) recommenda-tions in the maintenance schedule.The oil and filter collect contami-nants that can damage your engine ifthey are not removed regularly.

Changing the oil and filter requiresspecial tools and access fromunderneath the car. The car shouldbe raised on a service station-typehydraulic lift for this service. Unlessyou have the knowledge and properequipment, you should have thismaintenance done by a skilledmechanic.

1.

2.

4.

3.

CONTINUED

Changing the Oil and Filter

Engine Oil

Maintenance 211

WWAASSHHEERR OOIILL FFIILLTTEERRDDRRAAIINN BBOOLLTT

01/06/02 17:19:15 31S5A610_214

Page 215: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Put a new washer on the drain bolt,then reinstall the drain bolt.Tighten it to:

Replace the engine oil fill cap.Start the engine. The oil pressureindicator light should go out withinfive seconds. If it does not, turn offthe engine and reinspect yourwork.

Let the engine run for severalminutes and check the drain boltand oil filter for leaks.

Turn off the engine, let it sit forseveral minutes, then check the oillevel. If necessary, add oil to bringthe level to the upper mark on thedipstick.

Refill the engine with the recom-mended oil.Engine oil change capacity(including filter):

5.

6.

7.

8.

9.

(U.S.: DX, LX, Canada: DX, LX)

(U.S.: EX)

(U.S.: DX, LX, Canada: DX, LX)

(U.S.: EX)

Engine Oil

Maintenance212

33 lbf·ft (44 N·m , 4.5 kgf·m)

29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)

3.4 US qt (3.2 , 2.8 Imp qt)

3.7 US qt (3.5 , 3.1 Imp qt)

Improper disposal of engine oil can beharmf ul to the environment. If youchange your own oil, please dispose ofthe used oil properly. Put it in a sealedcontainer and take it to a recyclingcenter. Do not discard it in a trash binor dump it on the ground.

01/06/02 17:19:26 31S5A610_215

Page 216: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If the coolant level in the reservetank is at or below the MIN line, addcoolant to bring it up to the MAX line.Inspect the cooling system for leaks.This coolant should always be amixture of 50 percent antifreeze and50 percent water. Never add straightantifreeze or plain water.

If the reserve tank is completelyempty, you should also check thecoolant level in the radiator.

Make sure the engine and radiatorare cool.

Always use Honda All SeasonAntifreeze/Coolant Type 2. Thiscoolant is pre-mixed with 50 percentantifreeze and 50 percent water. Itdoes not require any additionalmixing. If it is not available, you mayuse another major-brand non-silicatecoolant as a temporary replacement.Make sure it is a high-quality coolantrecommended for aluminum engines.However, continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result incorrosion, causing the coolingsystem to malfunction or fail. Havethe cooling system flushed andrefilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible. 1.

CONTINUED

Adding Engine Coolant

Cooling System

Maintenance 213

RREESSEERRVVEE TTAANNKK

Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.

Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.

01/06/02 17:19:35 31S5A610_216

Page 217: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Remove the radiator cap bypushing down and turningcounterclockwise.

Turn the radiator cap counter-clockwise, without pressing downon it, until it stops. This relievesany pressure remaining in thecooling system.

Pour coolant into the reserve tank.Fill it to halfway between the MAXand MIN marks. Put the cap backon the reserve tank.

Put the radiator cap back on.Tighten it fully.

The coolant level should be up tothe base of the filler neck. Addcoolant if it is low.

Do not add any rust inhibitors orother additives to your car’s coolingsystem. They may not be compatiblewith the coolant or engine compo-nents.

2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

Cooling System

Maintenance214

RRAADDIIAATTOORR CCAAPP RREESSEERRVVEE TTAANNKK

01/06/02 17:19:46 31S5A610_217

Page 218: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Remove the radiator cap.

Turn the ignition ON (II). Turnthe temperature control dial tomaximum heat. Turn off theignition. Open the hood. Makesure the engine and radiator arecool to the touch.

Draining the coolant requires accessto the underside of the car. Unlessyou have the tools and knowledge,you should have this maintenancedone by a skilled mechanic.

The cooling system should becompletely drained and refilled withnew coolant according to the timeand distance recommendations inthe maintenance schedule. Only useHonda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2.

Loosen the drain plug on thebottom of the radiator. Thecoolant will drain through thesplash guard. Remove the drainbolt and washer from the engineblock. Drain the coolant into anappropriate container.

1. 3.

2.

Replacing Engine Coolant

Cooling System

Maintenance 215

DDRRAAIINNPPLLUUGG

DDRRAAIINN BBOOLLTT

01/06/02 17:19:56 31S5A610_218

Page 219: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

+-

-+

To remove the reserve tank todrain the coolant, first remove thebattery.

Put the tube back in the clips andput the reserve tank back in place,making sure its bottom tab is inthe holder. Reinstall and tightenthe mounting bolt securely.

Reinstall the tray, battery, stay,battery case, and battery plate inthe reverse order of removal.Reinstall and tighten the bolt andnut securely.

Reconnect the battery cables tothe terminals. Connect the positive( ) cable first, then the negative( ) cable.

Battery posts,terminals and related accessoriescontain lead and lead compounds.

Disconnect the battery cablesfrom the terminals. Disconnectthe negative ( ) cable first, thenthe positive ( ) cable.

Remove the bolt and the nut witha wrench, and remove the batteryplate. Pull the bottom end of thestay out of the hole, and removethe stay and the battery cover.

Remove the battery and the tray.

Remove the reserve tankmounting bolt with a wrench, thenremove the coolant tube from thethree clips. Remove the reservetank from its holder and drain thecoolant into an appropriatecontainer.

4. 6.

7.

5.

8.

9.

10.

Cooling System

Maintenance

WARNING:

Wash hands after handling.

216

BBOOLLTT

TTAABB

CCOOVVEERR

SSTTAAYY

BBOOLLTTNNUUTT

PPLLAATTEE

01/06/02 17:20:09 31S5A610_219

Page 220: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Pour Honda All SeasonAntifreeze/Coolant Type 2 intothe radiator up to the base of thefiller neck. This coolant is amixture of 50 percent antifreezeand 50 percent water. Pre-mixingis not required.

The cooling system capacity is:

Tightening torque:

Put a new washer on the drain bolt,then reinstall the drain bolt in theengine block. Tighten it securely.

When the coolant stops draining,tighten the drain plug at thebottom of the radiator.

When the audio system disablesitself, the clock setting will cancel.To reset the clock, refer to theDigital Clock in the audio system’soperation.

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, the audio system willdisable itself. The next time you turnon the radio you will see ‘‘ ’’in the frequency display. Use thePreset buttons to enter the five-digitcode (see page ).

12.

11.

13.

157

With 5-speed manual transmission:

With automatic transmission:

On the U.S. EX, and Canadian LX andDX-GOP models

Cooling System

Maintenance 217

FFIILLLLEERR NNEECCKK

FFiillll uupp ttoo hheerree

1.06 US gal (4.0 , 0.88 Imp gal)

1.03 US gal (3.9 , 0.86 Imp gal)

58 lbf·ft (78 N·m , 8.0 kgf·m)

01/06/02 17:20:23 31S5A610_220

Page 221: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Start the engine and hold it at1,500 rpm until the radiator fancomes on. Turn off the engine.Check the coolant level in theradiator and add coolant if needed.

Install the radiator cap, andtighten it fully.

If necessary, fill the reserve tankto the MAX mark. Install thereserve tank cap.

Start the engine and let it run forabout 30 seconds. Then turn offthe engine.

Check the level in the radiator,add coolant if needed.

Fill the reserve tank to the MAXmark. Install the reserve tank cap.

Install the radiator cap, andtighten it to the first stop.

Start the engine and let it run untilthe radiator cooling fan comes onat least twice. Then stop theengine.

Remove the radiator cap. Fill theradiator with coolant up to thebase of the filler neck.

14.

15.

16.

17.

18.

19.

20.

21.

22.

Cooling System

Maintenance218

01/06/02 17:20:34 31S5A610_221

Page 222: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Check the level in the windshieldwasher reservoir at least monthlyduring normal usage. In bad weather,when you use the washers often,check the level every time you stopfor fuel.

When you refill the reservoir, cleanthe edges of the windshield wiperblades with windshield washer fluidon a clean cloth. This will help tocondition the blade edges.

The windshield washer reservoir islocated behind the driver’s sideheadlight. Check the reservoir’s fluidlevel by removing the cap andlooking at the level gauge attachedto the cap.

Fill the reservoir with a good-qualitywindshield washer fluid. Thisincreases the cleaning capability andprevents freezing in cold weather.

The low washer level indicator willlight when the level is low (see page

).63

On Canadian models

Windshield Washers

Maintenance 219

LLEEVVEELL GGAAUUGGEE

WWIINNDDSSHHIIEELLDD WWAASSHHEERR RREESSEERRVVOOIIRR

Do not use engine antif reeze or avinegar/water solution in thewindshield washer reservoir.

Antif reeze can damage your car’s paint,while a vinegar/water solution candamage the windshield washer pump.

Use only commercially-availablewindshield washer f luid.

01/06/02 17:20:44 31S5A610_222

Page 223: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Insert the dipstick all the way intothe transmission securely asshown in the illustration.

Remove the dipstick and checkthe fluid level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.

Check the fluid level with the engineat normal operating temperature.

Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)from the transmission and wipe itwith a clean cloth.

Park the car on level ground. Shutoff the engine.

If the level is below the lowermark, add fluid into the filler holeto bring it to the upper mark.

Always use Honda ATF-Z1(Automatic Transmission Fluid). Ifit is not available, you may use aDEXRON III automatictransmission fluid as a temporaryreplacement. However, continueduse can affect shift quality. Havethe transmission flushed andrefilled with Honda ATF-Z1 assoon as it is convenient.

To thoroughly flush thetransmission, the technicianshould drain and refill it withHonda ATF-Z1, then drive thevehicle a short distance. Do thisthree times. Then drain and refillthe transmission a final time.

3.

4.

5.

1.

2.

Automatic Transmission

Transmission Fluid

Maintenance220

DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK

UUPPPPEERRMMAARRKKLLOOWWEERRMMAARRKK

01/06/02 17:20:57 31S5A610_223

Page 224: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If Honda MTF is not available, youmay use an API service SG, SH or SJgrade motor oil with a viscosity ofSAE 10W-30 or 10W-40 as atemporary replacement. An SGgrade is preferred, but an SH or SJgrade may be used if SG is notavailable. However, motor oil doesnot contain the proper additives andcontinued use can cause stiffershifting. Replace as soon as it isconvenient.

The transmission should be drainedand refilled with new fluid accordingto the time and distance recommen-dations in the maintenance schedule.

Insert the dipstick all the way backinto the transmission securely asshown in the illustration.

The transmission should be drainedand refilled with new fluid accordingto the time and distance recommen-dations in the maintenance schedule.

Check the fluid level with thetransmission at normal operatingtemperature and the car sitting onlevel ground. Remove thetransmission filler bolt and carefullyfeel inside the bolt hole with yourfinger. The fluid level should be upto the edge of the bolt hole. If it isnot, add Honda Manual Transmis-sion Fluid (MTF) until it starts torun out of the hole. Reinstall thefiller bolt and tighten it securely.

6.

Transmission Fluid

Maintenance

5-speed Manual Transmission

221

FFIILLLLEERR BBOOLLTT

CCoorrrreecctt LLeevveell

01/06/02 17:21:06 31S5A610_224

Page 225: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The fluid level should be betweenthe MIN and MAX marks on the sideof the reservoir. If the level is at orbelow the MIN mark, your brakesystem needs attention. Have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.

Always use Honda Heavy DutyBrake Fluid DOT 3. If it is notavailable, you should use only DOT 3or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealedcontainer, as a temporaryreplacement. However, the use ofany non-Honda brake fluid can causecorrosion and decrease the life of thesystem. Have the brake systemflushed and refilled with HondaHeavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 assoon as possible.

Check the fluid level in the reser-voirs monthly. There are up to tworeservoirs, depending on the model.They are:

Brake fluid reservoir (all models)Clutch fluid reservoir(manual transmission only)

Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is notcompatible with your car’s brakingsystem and can cause extensivedamage.

The brake fluid should be replacedaccording to the time recommenda-tion in the maintenance schedule.

Brake and Clutch Fluid

Maintenance

Brake System

222

MMAAXX

MMIINN

01/06/02 17:21:16 31S5A610_225

Page 226: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The fluid should be between theMIN and MAX marks on the side ofthe reservoir. If it is not, add brakefluid to bring it up to that level. Usethe same fluid specified for thebrake system.

Low fluid level can indicate a leak inthe clutch system. Have this systeminspected as soon as possible.

Brake and Clutch Fluid

Maintenance

Clutch System

223

MMAAXX

MMIINN

01/06/02 17:21:22 31S5A610_226

Page 227: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

A low power steering fluid level canindicate a leak in the system. Checkthe fluid level frequently and havethe system inspected as soon aspossible.

Always use Honda Power SteeringFluid. If it is not available, you mayuse another power steering fluid asan emergency replacement.However, continued use can causeincreased wear and poor steering incold weather. Have the powersteering system flushed and refilledwith Honda PSF as soon as possible.

Check the level when the engine iscold. Look at the side of thereservoir. The fluid should bebetween the UPPER LEVEL andLOWER LEVEL. If it is below theLOWER LEVEL, add power steeringfluid to the UPPER LEVEL.

Power Steering

Maintenance224

UUPPPPEERR LLEEVVEELL

LLOOWWEERR LLEEVVEELL

Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef tor right lock and holding it there candamage the power steering pump.

01/06/02 17:21:30 31S5A610_227

Page 228: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Carefully clean the inside of theair cleaner housing with a damprag.

Place the new air cleaner elementin the air cleaner housing.

The air cleaner element is inside theair cleaner housing in the enginecompartment.

To replace it:

Loosen the seven bolts andremove the air cleaner housingcover.

Remove the old air cleanerelement. Reinstall the air cleaner housing

cover, tighten the seven bolts.

The air cleaner element should bereplaced according to the distancerecommendation in the maintenanceschedule.

1.

3.

2.

4.

5.

Replacement

Maintenance

Air Cleaner Element

225

AAIIRR CCLLEEAANNEERR EELLEEMMEENNTT

BBOOLLTTSS

BBOOLLTTSS

01/06/02 17:21:41 31S5A610_228

Page 229: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Clean the hood latch assembly with amild cleaner, then lubricate it with amultipurpose grease. Lubricate allthe moving parts (as shown),including the pivot. Follow the timeand distance recommendations inthe Maintenance Schedule. If youare not sure how to clean and greasethe latch, contact your Honda dealer.

Maintenance

Hood Latch

226

PPIIVVOOTTSS

LLAATTCCHHAASSSSEEMMBBLLYY

01/06/02 17:21:46 31S5A610_229

Page 230: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Disconnect the wire connectorfrom the ignition coil by pushingon the lock tab and pulling on theconnector. Pull on the plasticconnector, not the wires.

Loosen the two holding clips byturning the heads one-quarter turncounterclockwise with a flat-tippedscrewdriver. Remove the cover bypulling it straight up.

The spark plugs in your car are aspecial platinum-tipped design forlonger life. The spark plugs shouldbe replaced according to thedistance recommendation in themaintenance schedule.

Clean up any dirt and oil that havecollected around the ignition coils.

1.

2.

3.

CONTINUED

Maintenance

Spark Plugs

Replacement

227

CCOONNNNEECCTTOORR LLOOCCKK TTAABBHHOOLLDDIINNGG CCLLIIPPSS

IIGGNNIITTIIOONN CCOOIILL

01/06/02 17:21:55 31S5A610_230

Page 231: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Put the new spark plug into thesocket; then screw it into the hole.Screw it in by hand so you do notcrossthread it.

Torque the spark plug. (If you donot have a torque wrench, tightenthe spark plug two-thirds of a turnafter it contacts the cylinder head.)Tightening torque:

Remove the spark plug witha five-eighths inch (16 mm) sparkplug socket.

Use a wrench to remove the nutholding the ignition coil. Removethe ignition coil by pulling itstraight out.

4.

5.

6. 7.

Spark Plugs

Maintenance228

NNUUTT

13 lbf·ft (18 N·m , 1.8 kgf·m)

01/06/02 17:22:05 31S5A610_231

Page 232: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

+-

Spark Plug Gap:

Push the wire connector onto theignition coil. Make sure it locks inplace.

Repeat this procedure for theother three spark plugs.

Install the ignition coil. Reinstallthe nut.

Reinstall the cover. Secure thecover by turning the heads of thetwo holding clips one-quarter turnclockwise with a flat-tippedscrewdriver.

NGK:DENSO:

8.

11.

10.

9.

Maintenance

Spark Plugs

Specifications:

229

PZFR6F-11PKJ20CR-M11

0.04 in (1.1 mm) 00.1 mm

Tighten the spark plugs caref ully. Aspark plug that is too loose canoverheat and damage the engine.Overtightening can cause damage tothe threads in the cylinder head.

01/06/02 17:22:16 31S5A610_232

Page 233: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Check the battery terminals forcorrosion (a white or yellowishpowder). To remove it, cover theterminals with a solution of bakingsoda and water. It will bubble up andturn brown. When this stops, wash itoff with plain water. Dry off thebattery with a cloth or paper towel.Coat the terminals with grease tohelp prevent future corrosion.

Check the battery condition bylooking at the test indicator windowon the battery.The label on the battery explains thetest indicator’s colors.

Check the condition of your car’sbattery monthly. You should checkthe color of the test indicator window,and for corrosion on the terminals.

Battery posts,terminals and related accessoriescontain lead and lead compounds.

Battery

Maintenance

WARNING:

Wash hands after handling.

230

TTEESSTT IINNDDIICCAATTOORR WWIINNDDOOWW

01/06/02 17:22:24 31S5A610_233

Page 234: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If the terminals are severely cor-roded, clean them with baking sodaand water. Then use a wrench toloosen and remove the cables fromthe terminals. Always disconnect thenegative ( ) cable first and recon-nect it last. Clean the battery termi-nals with a terminal cleaning tool orwire brush. Reconnect and tightenthe cables, then coat the terminalswith grease.

If you need to connect the battery toa charger, disconnect both cables toprevent damage to the car’selectrical system.

If your car’s battery is disconnectedor goes dead, the audio system willdisable itself. The next time you turnon the radio you will see ‘‘ ’’in the frequency display. Use thePreset buttons to enter the five-digitcode (see page ).

When the battery is disconnected,the clock setting in the audio systemwill be canceled. You will need resetthe clock according to theinstructions of the audio system.

157

On all models

On the U.S. EX, and Canadian LX andDX-GOP models

Battery

Maintenance 231

The battery gives off explosivehydrogen gas during normaloperation.

A spark or flame can cause thebattery to explode with enoughforce to kill or seriously hurt you.

Wear protective clothing and aface shield, or have a skilledmechanic do the batterymaintenance.

Charging the battery with the cablesconnected can seriously damage yourcar’s electronic controls. Detach thebattery cables bef ore connecting thebattery to a charger.

01/06/02 17:22:34 31S5A610_234

Page 235: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Disconnect the blade assemblyfrom the wiper arm by pushing inthe lock tab. Hold it in while youpush the blade assembly towardthe base of the arm.

Raise the wiper arm off thewindshield.

To replace the blade:

Check the condition of the wiperblades at least every six months.Look for signs of cracking in therubber, or areas that are gettinghard. Replace the blades if you findthese signs, or they leave streaksand unwiped areas when used.

2.

1.

Wiper Blades

Maintenance232

WWIIPPEERR AARRMMSS

LLOOCCKK TTAABB

01/06/02 17:22:42 31S5A610_235

Page 236: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Remove the blade from its holderby grasping the tabbed end of theblade. Pull firmly until the tabscome out of the holder.

Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metal rein-forcement along the back edge,remove the metal reinforcementstrips from the old wiper blade andinstall them in the slots along theedge of the new blade.

Slide the new wiper blade into theholder until the tabs lock.

Slide the wiper blade assemblyonto the wiper arm. Make sure itlocks in place.

Lower the wiper arm down againstthe windshield.

3. 4.

5.

6.

7.

Wiper Blades

Maintenance 233

BBLLAADDEE

BBLLAADDEE

RREEIINNFFOORRCCEEMMEENNTT

01/06/02 17:22:52 31S5A610_236

Page 237: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Periodically check the engine’sradiator and air conditioningcondenser for leaves, insects, anddirt stuck to the front surface. Theseblock the air flow and reduce coolingefficiency. Use a light spray from ahose or a soft brush to remove them.

If the air conditioning does not get ascold as before, have your dealercheck the system. Recharge thesystem with Refrigerant HFC-134a(R-134a). (See Specifications on page

.)

Run the air conditioning at least oncea week during the cold weathermonths. Run it for at least tenminutes while you are driving at asteady speed with the engine atnormal operating temperature. Thiscirculates the lubricating oil con-tained in the refrigerant.

Your car’s air conditioning is a sealedsystem. Any major maintenance,such as recharging, should be doneby a qualified mechanic. You can doa couple of things to make sure theair conditioning works efficiently.

297

Standard for LX and EX models inthe U.S., and DX-GOP andLX models in CanadaOptional for other models

Air Conditioning System

Maintenance234

AAIIRR CCOONNDDIITTIIOONNIINNGG CCOONNDDEENNSSEERR

Whenever you have the air conditioningsystem serviced, make sure the servicef acility uses a ref rigerant recyclingsystem. This system captures theref rigerant f or reuse. Releasingref rigerant into the atmosphere candamage the environment.

The condenser and radiator f ins bendeasily. Only use a low-pressure sprayor sof t-bristle brush to clean them.

01/06/02 17:23:01 31S5A610_237

Page 238: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To replace it:

Open the glove box. Remove thehooks on the side panels by pullingout on the tabs. Pivot the glovebox out of the way.

The dust and pollen filter removespollen and dust that is brought infrom the outside through the heatingand cooling system.

This filter should be replaced every30,000 miles (48,000 km) undernormal conditions. It should bereplaced every 15,000 miles (24,000km) if you drive primarily in urbanareas that have high concentrationsof soot in the air from industry anddiesel-powered vehicles. Replace itmore often if air flow from theheating and cooling system becomesless than usual.

The dust and pollen filter is locatedbehind the glove box.

Remove the dust and pollen filtercover by pushing in on the lock tab,then pulling the cover toward you.

1.

2.

CONTINUED

Standard for LX and EX models inthe U.S., and LX and DX-GOP models inCanadaOptional for other models

Maintenance

Replacement

Dust and Pollen Filter

235

HHOOOOKKSS

TTAABB

CCOOVVEERR

01/06/02 17:23:13 31S5A610_238

Page 239: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Remove the first filter by pulling itstraight out of the air conditioningunit. Remove the second filter bysliding it to the left, then pulling itout.

Install the new filters. Reinstall thecover.

Pivot the glove box up intoposition. Reinstall the hooks intothe side panel of the glove box.Close the glove box.

If you are not sure how to replacethe dust and pollen filters, have themreplaced by your Honda dealer.

3.

4.

5.

Maintenance

Dust and Pollen Filter

236

DDUUSSTT AANNDD PPOOLLLLEENN FFIILLTTEERRSS

01/06/02 17:23:21 31S5A610_239

Page 240: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- -

- -

- -

The belts should have the following‘‘play’’ or deflection. The timing belt should normally be

replaced at the intervals shown inthe maintenance schedule.

In very high temperatures(over 110°F, 43°C).In very low temperatures(under 20°F, 29°C).

Replace this belt at 60,000 miles (U.S.)or 100,000 km (Canada) if youregularly drive your car in one ormore of these conditions:

Power steering belt:

Alternator belt:

Check the condition of the two drivebelts. Examine the edges of eachbelt for cracks or fraying.

If you see signs of wear or looseness,have your dealer adjust or replacethe belts.

Check the tension of each belt bypushing on it with your thumbmidway between the pulleys.

Drive Belts Timing Belt

Drive Belts, Timing Belt

Maintenance 237

AALLTTEERRNNAATTOORR BBEELLTT

PPOOWWEERR SSTTEEEERRIINNGG BBEELLTT

0.51 0.65 in (13.0 16.5 mm)

0.33 0.43 in (8.5 11.0 mm)

01/06/02 17:23:33 31S5A610_240

Page 241: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

We recommend that you visuallycheck your tires every day. If youthink a tire might be low, check itimmediately with a tire gauge.

To safely operate your car, your tiresmust be the proper type and size, ingood condition with adequate tread,and correctly inflated. The followingpages give more detailed informationon how and when to check airpressure, how to inspect your tiresfor damage and wear, and what to dowhen your tires need to be replaced.

Keeping the tires properly inflatedprovides the best combination ofhandling, tread life and ridingcomfort. Underinflated tires wearunevenly, adversely affect handlingand fuel economy, and are morelikely to fail from being overheated.Overinflated tires can make your carride more harshly, are more prone todamage from road hazards, and wearunevenly.

Use a gauge to measure the airpressure at least once a month. Eventires that are in good condition maylose one to two psi (10 to 20 kPa, 0.1to 0.2 kgf/cm ) per month.Remember to check the spare tire atthe same time you check all theother tires.

Check the pressure in the tires whenthey are cold. This means the carhas been parked for at least threehours. If you have to drive the carbefore checking the tire pressure,the tires can still be considered‘‘cold’’ if you drive less than 1 mile(1.6 km).

If you check the pressure when thetires are hot (the car has been drivenseveral miles), you will see readings4 to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to 0.4kgf/cm ) higher than the coldreading. This is normal. Do not letair out to match the specified coldpressure. The tire will beunderinflated.

You should get your own tirepressure gauge and use it wheneveryou check your tire pressures. Thiswill make it easier for you to tell if apressure loss is due to a tire problemand not due to a variation betweengauges.

Inflation

Tires

Maintenance238

Using tires that are excessivelyworn or improperly inflated cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.

Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding tireinflation and maintenance.

01/06/02 17:23:44 31S5A610_241

Page 242: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The following chart shows therecommended cold tire pressures formost normal driving conditions andspeeds.

These pressures are also given onthe tire information label on thedriver’s doorjamb.

Tubeless tires have some ability toself-seal if they are punctured.However, because leakage is oftenvery slow, you should look closelyfor punctures if a tire starts losingpressure.

Honda strongly recommends thatyou not drive faster than postedspeed limits and conditions allow. Ifyou decide it is safe to drive at highspeeds, be sure to adjust the cold tirepressures as shown in the nextcolumn. If you do not adjust the tirepressure, excessive heat can build upand cause sudden tire failure.

When you return to normal speeddriving, be sure to readjust the tirepressure for normal driving. Youshould wait until the tires are coldbefore adjusting the tire pressure.

Tire Pressures for high speeddriving are the same as for normaldriving.

The compact spare tire pressure is:

(DX, U.S. LX)

(DX, U.S. LX)

(EX, Canadian LX)

Cold Tire Pressurefor Speeds over 100mph (160 km/h)

Tire Size

Tire Size Cold Tire Pressurefor Normal Driving

Tire Size Cold Tire Pressurefor Normal Driving

DX and U.S. LX models only EX and Canadian LX models only

Tires

Maintenance

Recommended Tire Pressures forNormal Driving

Tire Pressure Adjustment for HighSpeed Driving

239

35 psi (240 kPa , 2.4kgf/cm )

P185/70R14 87S

P185/70R14 87S 30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1kgf/cm )

30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1kgf/cm )

P185/65R15 86H

60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )

01/06/02 17:24:00 31S5A610_242

Page 243: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Every time you check inflation, youshould also examine the tires fordamage, foreign objects, and wear.

You should look for:

Bumps or bulges in the tread orside of the tire. Replace the tire ifyou find either of these conditions.

Excessive tread wear.

In addition to proper inflation,correct wheel alignment helps todecrease tire wear. If you find a tireis worn unevenly, have your dealercheck the wheel alignment.

Cuts, splits, or cracks in the sideof the tire. Replace the tire if youcan see fabric or cord.

The tires were properly balanced bythe factory. They may need to berebalanced at some time before theyare worn out. Have your dealercheck the tires if you feel a consis-tent vibration while driving. A tireshould always be rebalanced if it isremoved from the wheel for repair.

Your car’s tires have wear indicatorsmolded into the tread. When thetread wears down to that point, youwill see a 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) wideband running across the tread. Thisshows there is less than 1/16 inch(1.6 mm) of tread left on the tire. Atire that is this worn gives very littletraction on wet roads. You shouldreplace the tire if you can see thetread wear indicator in three or moreplaces around the tire.

Inspection Maintenance

Tires

Maintenance240

IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLOOCCAATTIIOONN MMAARRKKSS

TTRREEAADD WWEEAARR IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:24:14 31S5A610_243

Page 244: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When shopping for replacementtires, you may find that some tiresare ‘‘directional.’’ This means theyare designed to rotate only in onedirection. If you use directional tires,they should be rotated only front-to-back.

Make sure the installer balances thewheels when you have new tiresinstalled. This increases ridingcomfort and tire life. Your car’soriginal tires were dynamic or ‘‘spin’’balanced at the factory. For bestresults, have the installer perform adynamic balance.

To help increase tire life anddistribute wear more evenly, youshould have the tires rotated every10,000 miles (16,000 km). Move thetires to the positions shown in thechart each time they are rotated.

Tire Rotation

Tires

Maintenance 241

((FFoorr NNoonn--ddiirreeccttiioonnaallTTiirreess aanndd WWhheeeellss))

((FFoorr DDiirreeccttiioonnaallTTiirreess aanndd WWhheeeellss))

FFrroonntt FFrroonntt

01/06/02 17:24:21 31S5A610_244

Page 245: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The tires that came with your carwere selected to match the perform-ance capabilities of the car whileproviding the best combination ofhandling, ride comfort, and long life.You should replace them with radialtires of the same size, load range,speed rating, and maximum cold tirepressure rating (as shown on thetire’s sidewall). Mixing radial andbias-ply tires on your car can reduceits braking ability, traction, andsteering accuracy. It is best to replace all four tires at

the same time. If that is not possibleor necessary, then replace the twofront tires or the two rear tires as apair. Replacing just one tire canseriously affect your car’s handling.

The ABS works by comparing thespeed of the wheels. When replacingtires, use the same size originallysupplied with the car. Tire size andconstruction can affect wheel speedand may cause the system to workinconsistently.

If you ever need to replace a wheel,make sure the wheel’s specificationsmatch those of the original wheelthat came on your car. Replacementwheels are available at your Hondadealer.

Replacing Tires and Wheels

Tires

Maintenance242

Installing improper tires on yourcar can affect handling andstability. This can cause a crashin which you can be seriouslyhurt or killed.

Always use the size and type oftires recommended in thisowner’s manual.

01/06/02 17:24:30 31S5A610_245

Page 246: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

+Wheels:

Tires that are marked ‘‘M S’’ or‘‘All Season’’ on the sidewall have anall-weather tread design. Theyshould be suitable for most winterdriving conditions. Tires withoutthese markings are designed foroptimum traction in dry conditions.They may not provide adequateperformance in winter driving.For the best performance in snowyor icy conditions, you should installsnow tires or tire chains. They maybe required by local laws undercertain conditions.

If you mount snow tires on yourHonda, make sure they are radialtires of the same size and load rangeas the original tires. Mount snowtires on all four wheels to balanceyour car’s handling in all weatherconditions. Keep in mind the tractionprovided by snow tires on dry roadsmay not be as high as your car’soriginal equipment tires. You shoulddrive cautiously even when the roadsare clear. Check with the tire dealerfor maximum speed recommenda-tions.

Tires:

See page for information aboutDOT Tire Quality Grading.

(DX, U.S. LX)

(DX, U.S. LX)

(EX, Canadian LX)

298

(EX, Canadian LX)

CONTINUED

Snow TiresWheels and Tires Winter Driving

Tires

Maintenance 243

14 x 5 1/2 JJ

P185/70R14 87S

P185/65R15 86H

15 x 6 JJ

01/06/02 17:24:42 31S5A610_246

Page 247: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Because your Honda has limited tireclearance, mount only SAE Class ‘‘S’’cable-type traction devices on thefront tires. Use traction devices onlywhen required by driving conditionsor local laws. Make sure they are thecorrect size for your tires.

Metal link-type ‘‘chains’’ should notbe used. No matter how tight theyseem to be installed, they can comeinto contact with the body andsuspension, causing serious damage.

When installing cables, follow themanufacturer’s instructions andmount them as tightly as you can.Drive slowly with them installed. Ifyou hear them coming in contactwith the body or chassis, stop andinvestigate. Make sure the cables areinstalled tightly, and that they arenot contacting the brake lines orsuspension.Remove them as soon as you begindriving on cleared roads.

Tires

Maintenance

Tire Chains

244

Traction devices that are the wrongsize or improperly installed candamage your vehicle’s brake lines,suspension, body, and wheels. Stopdriving if they are hitting any part ofthe vehicle.

01/06/02 17:24:49 31S5A610_247

Page 248: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Check the operation of your car’sexterior lights at least once a month.A burned out bulb can create anunsafe condition by reducing yourcar’s visibility and the ability tosignal your intentions to otherdrivers.

CONTINUED

Lights

Maintenance 245

HHEEAADDLLIIGGHHTT

PPAARRKKIINNGG LLIIGGHHTT

TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALL//SSIIDDEE MMAARRKKEERR

01/06/02 17:24:55 31S5A610_248

Page 249: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Check the following:

Headlights (low and high beam)Parking lightsTaillightsBrake lightsHigh-mount brake lightTurn signalsBack-up lightsHazard light functionLicense plate lightSide marker lightsDaytime running lights(Canadian models)

If you find any bulbs are burned out,replace them as soon as possible.Refer to the chart on page todetermine what type of replacementbulb is needed.

297

Lights

Maintenance246

BBAACCKK--UUPP LLIIGGHHTT

LLIICCEENNSSEEPPLLAATTEE LLIIGGHHTTSS

TTAAIILLLLIIGGHHTT

HHIIGGHH--MMOOUUNNTTBBRRAAKKEE LLIIGGHHTT

SSTTOOPP//TTAAIILLLLIIGGHHTT//RREEAARR SSIIDDEE MMAARRKKEERR LLIIGGHHTT

TTUURRNN SSIIGGNNAALL LLIIGGHHTT

01/06/02 17:25:02 31S5A610_249

Page 250: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Open the hood.If you need to change the head-light bulb on the driver’s side,remove the power steeringreservoir tank by pulling it out ofits holder.

Your car has halogen headlightbulbs, one on each side. Whenreplacing a bulb, handle it by its steelbase and protect the glass fromcontact with your skin or hardobjects. If you touch the glass, cleanit with denatured alcohol and a cleancloth.

The headlights were properly aimedwhen your car was new. If youregularly carry heavy items in thetrunk, readjustment may be required.Adjustment of the headlights shouldbe performed by a Honda technicianor other qualified mechanic.

1.

CONTINUED

Replacing a Headlight BulbHeadlight Aiming

Lights

Maintenance 247

HHOOLLDDEERR

Halogen headlight bulbs get very hotwhen lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratchon the glass can cause the bulb tooverheat and shatter.

01/06/02 17:25:13 31S5A610_250

Page 251: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you are changing the bulb onthe driver’s side, start the engine,turn the steering wheel all the wayto the right, and turn off theengine. If you are changing thebulb on the passenger’s side, turnthe steering wheel to the left.

Reinstall the power steeringreservoir.

(Driver’s side)

Turn on the headlights to test thenew bulb.

Insert the new bulb into the hole,making sure the tabs are in theirslots. Pivot the hold-down wireback in place and clip the end intothe slot.

Install the rubber seal over theback of the headlight assembly.Make sure it is right side up; it ismarked ‘‘TOP.’’

Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pulling theconnector straight back.

Remove the rubber weather sealby pulling on the tab.

Unclip the end of the hold-downwire from its slot. Pivot it out ofthe way and remove the bulb.

Push the electrical connector ontothe new bulb. Make sure it isconnected securely.

3.

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

1.

2.

Lights

Maintenance

Replacing the Front Side Marker/Turn Signal and Parking LightBulbs

248

WWEEAATTHHEERR SSEEAALL BBUULLBB

CCOONNNNEECCTTOORR HHOOLLDD--DDOOWWNN WWIIRREE

01/06/02 17:25:27 31S5A610_251

Page 252: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Use a flat-tipped screwdriver toremove the holding clip from theinner fender.

Pull the inner fender cover back.

Remove the socket from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.

Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket.Push the new bulb straight intothe socket until it bottoms.

Insert the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.

Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.

Put the inner fender cover in place.Install the holding clip. Lock it inplace by pushing on the center.

3.

2. 4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

Lights

Maintenance 249

HHOOLLDDIINNGG CCLLIIPP

01/06/02 17:25:39 31S5A610_252

Page 253: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Open the trunk. Determine which of the two bulbsis burned out: stop/taillight/sidemarker light or turn signal light.

Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket.Push the new bulb straight intothe socket until it bottoms.

Reinstall the socket into the lightassembly by turning it clockwiseuntil it locks.

Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.

Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.

Reinstall the trunk lining. Makesure it is installed under the edgeof the trunk seal.

Remove the screws in the centerof each of the two fasteners on theside of the trunk lining. Pull thelining back.

Put the fasteners into the holes onthe side of the trunk lining.Reinstall the screws.

1. 2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

Replacing Rear Bulbs(in Fenders)

Lights

Maintenance250

FFAASSTTEENNEERRSS

01/06/02 17:25:54 31S5A610_253

Page 254: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Open the trunk and remove thesocket from the light assembly byturning it one-quarter turn counter-clockwise.

Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket.Push the new bulb straight intothe socket until it bottoms.

Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket.Push the new bulb straight intothe socket until it bottoms.

Insert the socket back into thelight assembly. Turn it clockwiseto lock it in place.

Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.

Open the trunk.

Determine which of the two bulbsis burned out: taillight or back-uplight.

Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.

1.

2.

4.

5.

6.

1.

2.

3.

CONTINUED

Lights

Maintenance

Replacing a High-mount BrakeLight Bulb

Replacing Rear Bulbs(in Trunk Lid)

251

01/06/02 17:26:09 31S5A610_254

Page 255: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Turn on the parking lights andcheck that the new bulb isworking.

Reinstall the socket. Turn itclockwise until it locks. Make surethe new bulb is working.

Reinstall the socket back in placeby pushing it in until it latches.

Open the trunk.

Remove the socket from the lightassembly by squeezing the tabs onboth sides of the socket.

Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb in untilit bottoms in the socket.

2.

1.

3. 4.

5.

3.

Lights

Maintenance

Replacing a Rear License PlateBulb

252

01/06/02 17:26:20 31S5A610_255

Page 256: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Pull the bulb straight out of theholder. Push the new bulb straightinto the holder until it bottoms.

Put the light assembly back intothe hole, right side first. Push onthe left side until it snaps intoplace.

Open the trunk.Put a cloth on the left side edge ofthe trunk light assembly. Removethe trunk light assembly by usinga small flat-tipped screwdriver topry carefully on the left edge ofthe assembly.

2.

3.

1.

Replacing the Trunk Light Bulb

Lights

Maintenance 253

01/06/02 17:26:30 31S5A610_256

Page 257: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Although the ceiling light andspotlights come apart the same way,they do not use the same type ofbulbs.

Remove the lens by carefullyprying on the edge of the lens witha fingernail file or a small flat-tipscrewdriver. Do not pry on theedge of the housing around thelens.

Remove the bulb by pulling itstraight out of its metal tabs.

Push the new bulb into the metaltabs. Snap the lens back in place.

Front ceiling light:Pry on the front edge of the lens inthe middle.

Ceiling light:Pry on the side edge of the lens inthe middle.

2.

3.

1.

Replacing Bulbs in the InteriorLights

Lights

Maintenance254

CCEEIILLIINNGG LLIIGGHHTT FFRROONNTT CCEEIILLIINNGG LLIIGGHHTT

EEXX

01/06/02 17:26:41 31S5A610_257

Page 258: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Remove the bulb by pulling itstraight out of the bulb holder.

Push the new bulb into the bulbholder.

Reinstall the lens by inserting theoutside edge first, then pushing onthe inside edge.

Check which bulb is burned out.Push on the lens of the oppositeside you are replacing.

Remove the lens of the burned outbulb by carefully prying on theedge between the lenses with afingernail file or a small flat-tippedscrewdriver.

2.

3.1.

4.

5.

On LX model

Lights

Maintenance 255

PPuusshh

SSPPOOTT LLIIGGHHTTSS

LLXX

01/06/02 17:26:51 31S5A610_258

Page 259: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Block the rear wheels.

Fill the fuel tank.

Change the engine oil and filter(see page ).

Wash and dry the exteriorcompletely.

Clean the interior. Make sure thecarpeting, floor mats, etc. arecompletely dry.

Leave the parking brake off. Putthe transmission in Reverse(5-speed manual) or Park(automatic).

If you need to park your car for anextended period (more than onemonth), there are several things youshould do to prepare it for storage.Proper preparation helps preventdeterioration and makes it easier toget your car back on the road. Ifpossible, store your car indoors.

If the car is to be stored for alonger period, it should besupported on jackstands so thetires are off the ground.

Leave one window open slightly (ifthe car is being stored indoors).

Disconnect the battery.

Support the front wiper bladearms with a folded towel or rag sothey do not touch the windshield.

To minimize sticking, apply asilicone spray lubricant to all doorand trunk seals. Also, apply avehicle body wax to the paintedsurfaces that mate with the doorand trunk seals.

Cover the car with a ‘‘breathable’’cover, one made from a porousmaterial such as cotton.Nonporous materials, such asplastic sheeting, trap moisture,which can damage the paint.

If possible, run the engine for awhile periodically (preferably oncea month).

If you store your car for 12 monthsor longer, have your Honda dealerperform the inspections called for inthe 24 months maintenance schedule(Normal Conditions) as soon as youtake it out of storage (see page ).The replacements called for in themaintenance schedule are notneeded unless the car has actuallyreached that time or mileage.

211

200

Storing Your Car

Maintenance256

01/06/02 17:27:05 31S5A610_259

Page 260: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Regular cleaning and polishing ofyour Honda helps to keep it ‘‘new’’looking. This section gives you hintson how to clean your car andpreserve its appearance: the paint,brightwork, wheels and interior. Alsoincluded are several things you cando to help prevent corrosion.

.................................Exterior Care . 258.....................................Washing . 258

.......................................Waxing . 259..........................Paint Touch-up . 259

..................................Interior Care . 260...................................Carpeting . 260.................................Floor Mats . 260

.........................................Fabric . 261...........................................Vinyl . 261

...................................Seat Belts . 261....................................Windows . 262

..........................Air Fresheners . 262....................Corrosion Protection . 263

.................................Body Repairs . 264

Appearance Care

Appearance Care 257

01/06/02 17:27:10 31S5A610_260

Page 261: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When you have washed and rinsedthe whole exterior, dry it with achamois or soft towel. Letting itair-dry will cause dulling and waterspots.

Only use the solvents and cleanersrecommended in this Owner’sManual.

Fill a bucket with cool water. Mixin a mild detergent, such asdishwashing liquid or a productmade especially for car washing.

Frequent washing helps preserveyour car’s beauty. Dirt and grit canscratch the paint, while tree sap andbird droppings can permanently ruinthe finish.

Wash your car in a shady area, not indirect sunlight. If the car is parked inthe sun, move it into the shade andlet the exterior cool down before youstart.

Rinse the car thoroughly with coolwater to remove loose dirt.

Wash the car using the water anddetergent solution and a soft-bristle brush, sponge, or soft cloth.Start at the top and work your waydown. Rinse frequently.

Check the body for road tar, treesap, etc. Remove these stains withtar remover or turpentine. Rinse itoff immediately so it does notharm the finish. Remember to re-wax these areas, even if the rest ofthe car does not need waxing.

As you dry the car, inspect it forchips and scratches that could allowcorrosion to start. Repair them withtouch-up paint (see page ).259

Exterior Care

Appearance Care

Washing

258

Chemical solvents and strong cleanerscan damage the paint, metal, andplastic on your car.

01/06/02 17:27:22 31S5A610_261

Page 262: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Polishes Polishes and cleaner/waxes can restore the shine to paintthat has oxidized and lost some of itsshine. They normally contain mildabrasives and solvents that removethe top layer of the finish. Youshould use a polish on your Honda ifthe finish does not have its originalshine after using a wax.

Always wash and dry the whole carbefore waxing it. You should waxyour car, including the metal trim,whenever water sits on the surfacein large patches. It should form intobeads or droplets after waxing.

Cleaning tar, insects, etc. withremovers also takes off the wax.Remember to re-wax those areas,even if the rest of the car does notneed waxing.

Your dealer has touch-up paint tomatch your car’s color. The colorcode is printed on a sticker on thedriver’s doorjamb. Take this code toyour dealer so you are sure to getthe correct color.

Inspect your car frequently for chipsor scratches in the paint. Repairthem right away to prevent corrosionof the metal underneath. Use thetouch-up paint only on small chipsand scratches. More extensive paintdamage should be repaired by aprofessional.

You should use a quality liquid orpaste wax. Apply it according to theinstructions on the container. Ingeneral, there are two types ofproducts:

Waxes A wax coats the finish andprotects it from damage by exposureto sunlight, air pollution, etc. Youshould use a wax on your Hondawhen it is new.

Exterior Care

Appearance Care

Waxing Paint Touch-up

259

01/06/02 17:27:33 31S5A610_262

Page 263: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Vacuum the carpeting frequently toremove dirt. Ground-in dirt will makethe carpet wear out faster.Periodically shampoo the carpet tokeep it looking new. Use one of thefoam-type carpet cleaners on themarket. Follow the instructions thatcome with the cleaner, applying itwith a sponge or soft brush. Keepthe carpeting as dry as possible bynot adding water to the foam.

If you replace it, use a genuineHonda floor mat that is designed tobe used with the floor mat anchor inyour car.

If you use a non-Honda floor mat inthe driver’s footwell, make sure itfits properly and that it can be usedwith the floor mat anchor.

Do not put additional floor mats ontop of the anchored mat, otherwisethe additional mats may slideforward and interfere with the pedals.

If you remove the floor mat, makesure to re-anchor it when you put itback in your car.

The genuine Honda driver’s floormat was designed to hook over thefloor mat anchor. This keeps thefloor mat from sliding forward andpossibly interfering with the pedals.

If equippedCarpeting Floor Mats

Appearance Care

Interior Care

260

01/06/02 17:27:44 31S5A610_263

Page 264: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Dirt build-up in the loops of the seatbelt anchors can cause the belts toretract slowly. Wipe the insides ofthe loops with a clean clothdampened in mild soap and warmwater or isopropyl alcohol.

Vacuum dirt and dust out of thematerial frequently. For generalcleaning, use a solution of mild soapand lukewarm water, letting it air dry.To clean off stubborn spots, use acommercially-available fabric cleaner.Test it on a hidden area of the fabricfirst, to make sure it does not bleachor stain the fabric. Follow theinstructions that come with thecleaner.

Remove dirt and dust with a vacuumcleaner. Wipe the vinyl with a softcloth dampened in a solution of mildsoap and water. Use the samesolution with a soft-bristle brush onmore difficult spots. You can also usecommercially-available spray orfoam-type vinyl cleaners.

If your seat belts get dirty, you canuse a soft brush with a mixture ofmild soap and warm water to cleanthem. Do not use bleach, dye, orcleaning solvents. They can weakenthe belt material. Let the belts air-dry before you use the car.

Fabric

Vinyl

Seat Belts

Interior Care

Appearance Care 261

LLOOOOPP

01/06/02 17:27:52 31S5A610_264

Page 265: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Clean the windows, inside and out,with a commercially-available glasscleaner. You can also use a mixtureof one part white vinegar to ten partswater. This will remove the haze thatbuilds up on the inside of thewindows. Use a soft cloth or papertowels to clean all glass and clearplastic surfaces. If you use a liquid air freshener,

make sure you fasten it securely so itdoes not spill as you drive.

If you want to use an air freshener/deodorizer in the interior of your car,it is best to use a solid type. Someliquid air fresheners contain chemi-cals that may cause parts of theinterior trim and fabric to crack ordiscolor.

Windows Air Fresheners

Interior Care

Appearance Care262

The rear window def ogger andantenna wires are bonded to the insideof the glass. Wiping vigorously up-and-down can dislodge and break thesewires. When cleaning the rear window,use gentle pressure and wipe side-to-side.

01/06/02 17:28:00 31S5A610_265

Page 266: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Two factors normally contribute tocausing corrosion in your car:

Moisture trapped in body cavities.Dirt and road salt that collects inhollows on the underside of thecar stays damp, promotingcorrosion in that area.

Removal of paint and protectivecoatings from the exterior andunderside of the car.

Many corrosion-preventive measuresare built into your Honda. You canhelp keep your car from corrodingby performing some simple periodicmaintenance:

Repair chips and scratches in thepaint as soon as you discover them.

Inspect and clean out the drainholes in the bottom of the doorsand body.

Check the floor coverings fordampness. Carpeting and floormats may remain damp for a longtime, especially in winter. Thisdampness can eventually causethe floor panels to corrode.

Use a high-pressure spray to cleanthe underside of your car. This isespecially important in areas thatuse road salt in winter. It is also agood idea in humid climates andareas subject to salt air. Carsequipped with ABS have a sensorand wiring at each wheel. Becareful not to damage them.

Have the corrosion-preventivecoatings on the underside of yourcar inspected and repairedperiodically.

1.

2.

Corrosion Protection

Appearance Care 263

01/06/02 17:28:10 31S5A610_266

Page 267: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When reporting your collision to theinsurance company, tell them youwant genuine Honda parts used inthe repair. Although most insurersrecognize the quality of originalparts, some may try to specify thatthe repairs be done with otheravailable parts. You should investi-gate this before any repairs havebegun.

Take your car to your authorizedHonda dealer for inspection after therepairs are completed. Your dealercan make sure that quality materialswere used, and that corrosion-preventive coatings were applied toall repaired and replaced parts.

Body repairs can affect your car’sresistance to corrosion. If your carneeds repairs after a collision, payclose attention to the parts used inthe repair and the quality of thework.

Make sure the repair facility usesgenuine Honda replacement bodyparts. Some companies make sheetmetal pieces that seem to duplicatethe original Honda body parts, butare actually inferior in fit, finish, andcorrosion resistance. Once installed,they do not give the same high-quality appearance.

Body Repairs

Appearance Care264

01/06/02 17:28:17 31S5A610_267

Page 268: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This section covers the more-common problems that motoristsexperience with their vehicles. Itgives you information about how tosafely evaluate the problem and whatto do to correct it. If the problem hasstranded you on the side of the road,you may be able to get going again.If not, you will also find instructionson getting your car towed.

......................Compact Spare Tire . 266....................Changing a Flat Tire . 267

..........If Your Engine Won’t Start . 272Nothing Happens or the StarterMotor Operates Very

.....................................Slowly . 272The Starter Operates

................................Normally . 273

................................Jump Starting . 274............If Your Engine Overheats . 276

.........Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 279..........Charging System Indicator . 280

.......Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 281.......................Readiness Codes . 282

...............Brake System Indicator . 283..................Closing the Moonroof . 284

..............................................Fuses . 285..........Checking and Replacing . 286

......................Emergency Towing . 290

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Taking Care of the Unexpected 265

01/06/02 17:28:22 31S5A610_268

Page 269: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Follow these precautions wheneveryou are using the compact spare tire:

The compact spare tire has a shortertread life than a regular tire. Replaceit when you can see the tread wearindicator bars. The replacementshould be the same size and designtire, mounted on the same wheel.The compact spare tire is notdesigned to be mounted on a regularwheel, and the compact wheel is notdesigned for mounting a regular tire.

Check the inflation pressure of thecompact spare tire every time youcheck the other tires. It should beinflated to:

Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h)under any circumstances.

This tire gives a harsher ride andless traction on some road sur-faces than the regular tire. Usegreater caution while driving onthis tire.

Do not mount snow chains on thecompact spare.

Your car has a compact spare tirethat takes up less space. Use thisspare tire as a temporary replace-ment only. Get your regular tirerepaired or replaced and put it backon your car as soon as you can.

The wheel of the compact sparetire is designed especially to fityour car. Do not use your sparetire on another vehicle unless it isthe same make and model.

Compact Spare Tire

Taking Care of the Unexpected266

IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLOOCCAATTIIOONN MMAARRKK

TTRREEAADD WWEEAARR IINNDDIICCAATTOORR BBAARR60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )

01/06/02 17:28:33 31S5A610_269

Page 270: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you have a flat tire while driving,stop in a safe place to change it.Stopping in traffic or on the shoulderof a busy road is dangerous. Driveslowly along the shoulder until youget to an exit or an area to stop thatis far away from the traffic lanes.

Park the car on firm, level andnon-slippery ground away fromtraffic. Put the transmission inPark (automatic) or Reverse(manual). Apply the parking brake.

Turn on the hazard warning lightsand turn the ignition switch toLOCK (0). Have all thepassengers get out of the car whileyou change the tire.

Open the trunk. Raise the trunkfloor mat and the trunk floor bylifting up on the back edge.

Take the tool kit out of the trunk.

Unscrew the wing bolt and takethe spare tire out of its well.

5.

4.

3.

2.

1.

CONTINUED

Changing a Flat Tire

Taking Care of the Unexpected 267

SSPPAARREE TTIIRREE TTRRUUNNKK FFLLOOOORR

TTOOOOLL KKIITT JJAACCKK

The car can easily roll off thejack, seriously injuring anyoneunderneath.

Follow the directions forchanging a tire exactly, andnever get under the car when itis supported only by the jack.

01/06/02 17:28:44 31S5A610_270

Page 271: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Turn the jack’s end bracketcounterclockwise to loosen it, thenremove the jack.

Loosen the four wheel nuts 1/2turn with the wheel wrench.

Find the jacking point nearest thewheel you are removing. Place thejack under the jacking point. Turnthe end bracket clockwise untilthe top of the jack contacts thejacking point. Make sure thejacking point tab is resting in thejack notch.

6. 7. 8.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Changing a Flat Tire

268

JJAACCKK

WWHHEEEELL WWRREENNCCHH

JJAACCKKIINNGG PPOOIINNTTSS

01/06/02 17:28:52 31S5A610_271

Page 272: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Remove the wheel nuts and wheelcover. The wheel cover cannot beremoved without first removingthe wheel nuts. Do not attempt toforcibly pry the wheel cover offwith a screwdriver or other tool.

Use the extension and wheelwrench as shown to raise the caruntil the flat tire is off the ground.

Remove the flat tire. Temporarilyplace the flat tire on the groundwith the outside surface of thewheel facing up. You could scratchthe wheel if you put it face down.

9. 10. 11.

Changing a Flat Tire

Taking Care of the Unexpected 269

WWHHEEEELL WWRREENNCCHH EEXXTTEENNSSIIOONN

WWHHEEEELLNNUUTTSS

WWHHEEEELL CCOOVVEERRWWHHEEEELL NNUUTTSS

01/06/02 17:29:03 31S5A610_272

Page 273: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Lower the car to the ground andremove the jack.

Put on the spare tire. Put thewheel nuts back on finger-tight,then tighten them in a crisscrosspattern with the wheel wrenchuntil the wheel is firmly againstthe hub. Do not try to tightenthem fully.

Before mounting the spare tire,wipe any dirt off the mountingsurface of the wheel and hub witha clean cloth. Wipe the hubcarefully, it may be hot fromdriving.

12. 13. 14.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Changing a Flat Tire

270

BBRRAAKKEE HHUUBB

01/06/02 17:29:10 31S5A610_273

Page 274: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Store the wheel cover in the trunk.Make sure it does not getscratched or damaged.

Tighten the wheel nuts securely inthe same crisscross pattern. Havethe wheel nut torque checked atthe nearest automotive servicefacility.Tighten the wheel nuts to:

Place the flat tire face down in thespare tire well.

Remove the spacer cone from thewing bolt, turn it over, and put itback on the bolt.

Secure the flat tire by screwingthe wing bolt back into its hole.

Store the jack in the trunk with theend bracket on the left side. Turnthe jack’s end bracket to lock it inplace. Store the tool kit.

Lower the trunk floor and trunkfloor mat, then close the trunk lid.

15. 16.

17.

18.

19.

20.

21.

Changing a Flat Tire

Taking Care of the Unexpected 271

WWIINNGG BBOOLLTT SSPPAACCEERRCCOONNEE

80 lbf·ft (108 N·m , 11 kgf·m)

Loose items can fly around theinterior in a crash and couldseriously injure the occupants.

Store the wheel, jack, and toolssecurely before driving.

01/06/02 17:29:23 31S5A610_274

Page 275: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Diagnosing why your engine won’tstart falls into two areas, dependingon what you hear when you turn thekey to START (III):

When you turn the ignition switch toSTART (III), you do not hear thenormal noise of the engine trying tostart. You may hear a clicking soundor series of clicks, or nothing at all.Check these things:

You hear nothing, or almostnothing. The engine’s startermotor does not operate at all, oroperates very slowly.

You can hear the starter motoroperating normally, or the startermotor sounds like it is spinningfaster than normal, but the enginedoes not start up and run.

Check the transmission interlock.If you have a manual transmission,the clutch pedal must be pushedall the way to the floor or thestarter will not operate. With anautomatic transmission, it must bein Park or Neutral.

Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).Turn on the headlights and checktheir brightness. If the headlightsare very dim or don’t light at all,the battery is discharged. See

on page .

Turn the ignition switch to START(III). If the headlights do not dim,check the condition of the fuses. Ifthe fuses are OK, there is proba-bly something wrong with theelectrical circuit for the ignitionswitch or starter motor. You willneed a qualified technician todetermine the problem. (See

on page .)

If the headlights dim noticeably orgo out when you try to start theengine, either the battery is dis-charged or the connections arecorroded. Check the condition ofthe battery and terminal connec-tions (see page ). You canthen try jump starting the car froma booster battery (see page ).

290

230

274

274

If Your Engine Won’t Start

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Nothing Happens or the StarterMotor Operates Very Slowly

Jump Starting

Emergency Towing

272

01/06/02 17:29:35 31S5A610_275

Page 276: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you find nothing wrong, you willneed a qualified technician to findthe problem. See

on page .

In this case, the starter motor’sspeed sounds normal, or even fasterthan normal, when you turn theignition switch to START (III), butthe engine does not run.

Your car has the ImmobilizerSystem. You should use aproperly-coded master or valet keyto start the engine (see page ).A key that is not properly codedwill cause the immobilizer systemindicator in the dash panel to blinkrapidly.

Are you using the proper startingprocedure? Refer to

on page .

Do you have fuel? Turn theignition switch to ON (II) for aminute and watch the fuel gauge.The low fuel level warning lightmay not be working, so you werenot reminded to fill the tank.

There may be an electricalproblem, such as no power to thefuel pump. Check all the fuses(see page ).78

179

286

290

If Your Engine Won’t Start

Taking Care of the Unexpected

EmergencyTowing

The Starter Operates Normally

Starting theEngine

273

01/06/02 17:29:45 31S5A610_276

Page 277: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If your car’s battery has run down,you may be able to start the engineby using a booster battery. Althoughthis seems like a simple procedure,you should take several precautions.

You cannot start a Honda with anautomatic transmission by pushingor pulling it.

To jump start your car, follow thesedirections closely:

Open the hood and check thephysical condition of the battery(see page ). In very coldweather, check the condition ofthe electrolyte. If it seems slushyor like ice, do not try jump startinguntil it thaws.

Turn off all the electrical acces-sories: heater, A/C, stereo system,lights, etc.Put the transmission in Neutral orPark, and set the parking brake.

1.

2.

230

Jump Starting

Taking Care of the Unexpected274

A battery can explode if you donot follow the correct procedure,seriously injuring anyonenearby.

Keep all sparks, open flames,and smoking materials awayfrom the battery.

If a battery sits in extreme cold, theelectrolyte inside can f reeze.Attempting to jump start with a f rozenbattery can cause it to rupture.

01/06/02 17:29:55 31S5A610_277

Page 278: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

-+

Connect the second jumper cableto the negative ( ) terminal onthe booster battery. Connect theother end to the grounding strapas shown. Do not connect thisjumper cable to any other part ofthe engine.

Connect one jumper cable to thepositive ( ) terminal on yourHonda’s battery. Connect theother end to the positive ( )terminal on the booster battery. If the booster battery is in another

vehicle, have an assistant startthat vehicle and run it at a fast idle.

The numbers in the illustration showyou the order to connect the jumpercables.

3. 4.

5.

CONTINUED

Jump Starting

Taking Care of the Unexpected 275

BBOOOOSSTTEERR BBAATTTTEERRYY

01/06/02 17:30:06 31S5A610_278

Page 279: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your car can overheat for severalreasons, such as lack of coolant or amechanical problem. The onlyindication may be the temperaturegauge climbing to or above the redmark. Or you may see steam orspray coming from under the hood.In either case, you should takeimmediate action.

The pointer of your car’s tempera-ture gauge should stay in the mid-range under most conditions. It maygo higher if you are driving up a longsteep hill on a very hot day. If itclimbs to the red mark, you shoulddetermine the reason.

Keep the ends of the jumper cablesaway from each other and any metalon the car until all are disconnected.Otherwise, you may cause anelectrical short.

Once your car is running, discon-nect the negative cable from yourcar, then from the booster battery.Disconnect the positive cable fromyour car, then the booster battery.

Start your car. If the starter motorstill operates slowly, check thejumper cable connections to makesure they have good metal-to-metal contact.

7.

6.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Jump Starting, If Your Engine Overheats

If Your Engine Overheats

276

Steam and spray from anoverheated engine canseriously scald you.

Do not open the hood if steamis coming out.

Driving with the temperature gaugepointer at the red mark can causeserious damage to your engine.

01/06/02 17:30:16 31S5A610_279

Page 280: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Safely pull to the side of the road.Put the transmission in Neutral orPark, and set the parking brake.Turn off the heating and coolingsystem and all other accessories.Turn on the hazard warningindicators.

If you see steam and/or spraycoming from under the hood, turnoff the engine.

If you do not see steam or spray,leave the engine running andwatch the temperature gauge. Ifthe high heat is due to overloading(climbing a long, steep hill on ahot day with the A/C running, forexample), the engine should startto cool down almost immediately.If it does, wait until the tempera-ture gauge comes down to the mid-point then continue driving.

If the temperature gauge stays atthe red mark, turn off the engine.

Wait until you see no more signsof steam or spray, then open thehood.

Look for any obvious coolant leaks,such as a split radiator hose.Everything is still extremely hot,so use caution. If you find a leak, itmust be repaired before youcontinue driving (see

on page ).

If you don’t find an obvious leak,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank (see page

). If the level is below theMIN mark, add coolant to halfwaybetween the MIN and MAX marks.

1.

2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

7.

290

169

Taking Care of the Unexpected

If Your Engine Overheats

EmergencyTowing

277

01/06/02 17:30:27 31S5A610_280

Page 281: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If there was no coolant in thereserve tank, you may also have toadd coolant to the radiator. Let theengine cool down until the pointerreaches the middle of the tempera-ture gauge, or lower, before check-ing the radiator.

Using gloves or a large heavycloth, turn the radiator capcounterclockwise, without pushingdown, to the first stop. Thisreleases any remaining pressure inthe cooling system. After thepressure releases, push down onthe cap and turn it until it comesoff.

Start the engine and set thetemperature control dial tomaximum. Add coolant to theradiator up to the base of the fillerneck. If you do not have theproper coolant mixture available,you can add plain water.Remember to have the coolingsystem drained and refilled withthe proper mixture as soon as youcan.

Put the radiator cap back ontightly. Run the engine and watchthe temperature gauge. If it goesback to the red mark, the engineneeds repair. (See

on page .)

If the temperature stays normal,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. If it hasgone down, add coolant to theMAX mark. Put the cap back ontightly.

8. 9.

10.

11.

12.

290

Taking Care of the Unexpected

If Your Engine Overheats

EmergencyTowing

278

Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.

Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.

01/06/02 17:30:36 31S5A610_281

Page 282: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This indicator should light when theignition switch is ON (II), and go outafter the engine starts. It shouldnever come on when the engine isrunning. If it starts flashing, itindicates that the oil pressuredropped very low for a moment, thenrecovered. If the indicator stays onwith the engine running, it showsthat the engine has lost oil pressureand serious engine damage ispossible. In either case, you shouldtake immediate action.

Safely pull off the road and shutoff the engine. Turn on the hazardwarning indicators.

If necessary, add oil to bring thelevel back to the full mark on thedipstick (see page ).

Let the car sit for a minute. Openthe hood and check the oil level(see page ). Although oil leveland oil pressure are not directlyconnected, an engine that is verylow on oil can lose pressure duringcornering and other drivingmaneuvers.

Start the engine and watch the oilpressure indicator. If the lightdoes not go out within ten seconds,turn off the engine. There is amechanical problem that needs tobe repaired before you cancontinue driving. (See

on page .)1.

2.

3.

4.

168

209

290

Low Oil Pressure Indicator

Taking Care of the Unexpected

EmergencyTowing

279

LLOOWW OOIILL PPRREESSSSUURREE IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

Running the engine with low oilpressure can cause serious mechanicaldamage almost immediately. Turn of fthe engine as soon as you can saf ely getthe car stopped.

01/06/02 17:30:46 31S5A610_282

Page 283: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

This indicator should come on whenthe ignition switch is ON (II), and goout after the engine starts. If itcomes on brightly when the engineis running, it indicates that thecharging system has stoppedcharging the battery.

By eliminating as much of theelectrical load as possible, you candrive several miles (kilometers)before the battery is too dischargedto keep the engine running. Drive toa service station or garage whereyou can get technical assistance.

Immediately turn off all electricalaccessories: radio, heater, A/C, reardefogger, cruise control, etc. Try notto use other electrically-operatedcontrols such as the power windows.Keep the engine running and takeextra care not to stall it. Starting theengine will discharge the batteryrapidly.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Charging System Indicator

280

CCHHAARRGGIINNGG SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:30:52 31S5A610_283

Page 284: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you have recently refueled yourcar, the cause of this indicatorcoming on could be a loose ormissing fuel fill cap. Check the capand tighten it until it clicks severaltimes. Replace the fuel fill cap if it ismissing. Tightening the cap will notmake the indicator turn offimmediately; it takes one driving trip.

If the indicator remains on past onedriving trip, or the fuel cap was notloose or missing, have the carchecked by the dealer as soon aspossible. Drive moderately until thedealer has inspected the problem.Avoid full-throttle acceleration anddriving at high speed.

You should also have the dealerinspect your car if this indicatorcomes on repeatedly, even though itmay turn off as you continue driving.

This indicator should light when theignition switch is ON (II), and go outafter the engine starts. If it comes onat any other time, it indicates one ofthe engine’s emissions controlsystems may have a problem. Eventhough you may feel no difference inyour car’s performance, it canreduce your fuel economy and causeyour car to put out excessiveemissions. Continued operation maycause serious damage.

CONTINUED

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Malfunction Indicator Lamp

281

MMAALLFFUUNNCCTTIIOONN IINNDDIICCAATTOORR LLAAMMPP

If you keep driving with themalf unction indicator lamp on, you candamage your car’s emissions controlsand engine. Those repairs may not becovered by your car’s warranties.

01/06/02 17:31:01 31S5A610_284

Page 285: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your car has certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that are part of the on-boarddiagnostics for the emissionssystems. In some states, part of theemissions testing is to make surethese codes are set. If they are notset, the test cannot be completed.

If your car’s battery has beendisconnected or gone dead, thesecodes are erased. It takes severaldays of driving under variousconditions to set the codes again.

If possible, do not take your car for astate emissions test until thereadiness codes are set. Refer toState Emissions Testing for moreinformation. (See page .)

To check if they are set, turn theignition ON (II), but do not start theengine. The Malfunction IndicatorLamp will come on for 20 seconds. Ifit then goes off, the readiness codesare set. If it blinks 5 times, thereadiness codes are not set.

305

Malfunction Indicator Lamp

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Readiness Codes

282

01/06/02 17:31:08 31S5A610_285

Page 286: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

**

** Slow down by shifting to a lowergear, and pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe. Because of thelonger distance needed to stop, it ishazardous to drive the car. Youshould have it towed, and repaired assoon as possible. (See

on page .)

If you must drive the car a shortdistance in this condition, driveslowly and cautiously.

If it comes on at any other time, itindicates a problem with the car’sbrake system. In most cases, theproblem is a low fluid level in thebrake fluid reservoir. Press lightly onthe brake pedal to see if it feelsnormal. If it does, check the brakefluid level the next time you stop at aservice station (see page ). If thefluid level is low, take the car to yourdealer and have the brake systeminspected for leaks or worn brakepads.

However, if the brake pedal does notfeel normal, you should takeimmediate action. Because of thebrake system’s dual-circuit design, aproblem in one part of the systemwill still give you braking at twowheels. You will feel the brake pedalgo down much farther before the carbegins to slow down, and you willhave to press harder on the pedal.The distance needed to stop will bemuch longer.

The Brake System Indicatornormally comes on when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). It is areminder to check the parking brake.It comes on and stays lit if you do notfully release the parking brake.

222290

EmergencyTowing

Brake System Indicator

Taking Care of the Unexpected 283

UU..SS.. iinnddiiccaattoorr sshhoowwnn

BBRRAAKKEE SSYYSSTTEEMM IINNDDIICCAATTOORR

01/06/02 17:31:16 31S5A610_286

Page 287: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Use a screwdriver or coin toremove the round plug in thecenter of the headliner.

Remove the wrench. Replace theround plug.

If the electric motor will not closethe moonroof, do the following:

Check the fuse for the moonroofmotor (see page ). If the fuseis blown, replace it with one of thesame or lower rating.

Try closing the moonroof. If thenew fuse blows immediately or themoonroof motor still does notoperate, you can close themoonroof manually.

Insert the moonroof wrench intothe socket behind this plug. Turnthe wrench until the moonroof isfully closed.

Get the moonroof wrench out ofthe tool kit in the trunk.

5.

6.

4.

1.

2.

3.

286

Closing the Moonroof

Taking Care of the Unexpected284

RROOUUNNDD PPLLUUGG

SSOOCCKKEETT

01/06/02 17:31:28 31S5A610_287

Page 288: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

All the electrical circuits in your carhave fuses to protect them from ashort circuit or overload. Thesefuses are located in two fuse boxes.

The interior fuse box is underneaththe steering column. To open it, turnthe knobs as shown.

The under-hood fuse box is locatedin the engine compartment on thepassenger’s side. To open it, pushthe tabs as shown.

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected 285

TTAABB

UUNNDDEERR--HHOOOODD IINNTTEERRIIOORR

01/06/02 17:31:36 31S5A610_288

Page 289: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If something electrical in your carstops working, the first thing youshould check for is a blown fuse.Determine from the chart on pages

and , or the diagram on thefuse box lid, which fuse or fusescontrol that component. Check thosefuses first, but check all the fusesbefore deciding that a blown fuse isnot the cause. Replace any blownfuses and check the component’soperation.

Turn the ignition switch to LOCK(0). Make sure the headlights andall other accessories are off.

Remove the cover from the fusebox.

Check each of the large fuses inthe under-hood fuse box bylooking through the top at the wireinside. Removing these fusesrequires a Phillips-head screw-driver.

Check the smaller fuses in theunder-hood fuse box and all thefuses in the interior fuse box bypulling out each fuse with the fusepuller provided in the under-hoodfuse box.

3.1.

2.

4.

288 289

Checking and Replacing Fuses

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected286

FFUUSSEE

BBLLOOWWNN

FFUUSSEE PPUULLLLEERR

01/06/02 17:31:47 31S5A610_289

Page 290: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Look for a burned wire inside thefuse. If it is burned, replace it withone of the spare fuses of the samerating or lower.

If the radio fuse is removed, theaudio system will disable itself. Thenext time you turn on the radio youwill see ‘‘ ’’ in the frequencydisplay. Use the Preset buttons toenter the five-digit code (see page

).

If the replacement fuse of thesame rating blows in a short time,there is probably a seriouselectrical problem in your car.Leave the blown fuse in thatcircuit and have your car checkedby a qualified mechanic.

When the audio system is disabled,the clock setting in the audio systemwill be canceled. You will need toreset the clock according to theinstructions of the audio system.

If you cannot drive the car withoutfixing the problem, and you do nothave a spare fuse, take a fuse of thesame rating or a lower rating fromone of the other circuits. Make sureyou can do without that circuittemporarily (such as the accessorypower socket or radio).

If you replace the blown fuse with aspare fuse that has a lower rating, itmight blow out again. This does notindicate anything wrong. Replace thefuse with one of the correct rating assoon as you can.

5.

6.

157

CONTINUED

On all models

On the U.S. EX, and Canadian LX andDX-GOP models

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected 287

BBLLOOWWNN

Replacing a f use with one that has ahigher rating greatly increases thechances of damaging the electricalsystem. If you do not have a replace-ment f use with the proper rating f or thecircuit, install one with a lower rating.

01/06/02 17:31:58 31S5A610_290

Page 291: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

No. Amps. Circuits Protected

123456789

1011121314151617181920

20 A15 A

7.5 A20 A10 A15 A15 A20 A10 A40 A30 A40 A40 A40 A15 A20 A15 A

80 A40 A

Condenser FanSmall LightInterior LightCooling FanHazardFI ECUHorn, StopABS F/SBack UpABS MotorRear DefrosterHeater MotorPower WindowOptionLeft HeadlightDoor LockRight HeadlightNot UsedBatteryIgnition 1Spare Fuses21 25 7.5A 30A

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Fuses

288

UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX

01/06/02 17:32:05 31S5A610_291

Page 292: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

No. Amps. Circuits Protected

No. Amps. Circuits Protected

: On Canadian models

12345

15 A20 A10 A10 A

Ignition CoilLAF HeaterDaytime running lightsAlternatorNot Used

6789

10111213141516171819202122232425

7.5 A20 A

7.5 A

7.5 A7.5 A7.5 A10 A10 A

15 A15 A

7.5 A20 A

20 A20 A20 A20 A

Power Window RelayMoonroofAccessory, RadioNot UsedMeterABSDaytime running lightsSRSRemote Control MirrorsNot UsedNot UsedFuel PumpAccessory Power SocketTurn Signal LightsFront WiperNot UsedFront Right Power WindowFront Left Power WindowRear Left Power WindowRear Right Power Window

Fuses

Taking Care of the Unexpected 289

INTERIOR FUSE BOX

01/06/02 17:32:14 31S5A610_292

Page 293: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The towtruck uses two pivoting arms that gounder the tires (front or rear) and liftthem off the ground. The other twotires remain on the ground.

If your car needs to be towed, call aprofessional towing service or, if youbelong to one, an organization thatprovides roadside assistance. Nevertow your car behind another vehiclewith just a rope or chain. It is verydangerous.

There are three popular types ofprofessional towing equipment.

The operatorloads your car on the back of a truck.

Release the parking brake.Shift the transmission to Neutral.

The towtruck uses metal cables with hookson the ends. These hooks go aroundparts of the frame or suspension andthe cables lift that end of the car offthe ground. Your car’s suspensionand body can be seriously damaged.

If your Honda cannot be transportedby flat-bed, it should be towed bywheel-lift equipment with the frontwheels off the ground. If due todamage, your car must be towedwith the front wheels on the ground,do the following:

Release the parking brake.Start the engine.Shift to D, then to N.Turn off the engine.

5-speed Manual Transmission

Automatic Transmission

Wheel-lif t Equipment

Flat-bed Equipment

Sling-type Equipment

This isan acceptable way to tow yourHonda.

This is the best way to transportyour Honda.

This method of towing isunacceptable.

Emergency Towing

Taking Care of the Unexpected290

Improper towing preparation willdamage the transmission. Follow theabove procedure exactly. If you cannotshif t the transmission or start theengine (automatic transmission), yourcar must be transported with the f rontwheels of f the ground.

01/06/02 17:32:26 31S5A610_293

Page 294: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you decide to tow your car with allfour wheels on the ground, makesure you use a properly-designed andattached tow bar. Prepare the car fortowing as described above, and leavethe ignition switch in Accessory (I)so the steering wheel does not lock.Make sure the radio and any itemsplugged into the accessory powersocket are turned off so they do notrun down the battery.

With the front wheels on the ground,it is best to tow the car no fartherthan 50 miles (80 km), and keep thespeed below 35 mph (55 km/h).

If your car is equipped with a frontspoiler, remove it before towing so itis not damaged.

Emergency Towing

Taking Care of the Unexpected 291

Trying to lif t or tow your car by thebumpers will cause serious damage.The bumpers are not designed tosupport the car’s weight.

The steering system can be damaged ifthe steering wheel is locked. Leave theignition switch in Accessory (I), andmake sure the steering wheel turnsf reely bef ore you begin towing.

01/06/02 17:32:34 31S5A610_294

Page 295: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

292

01/06/02 17:32:35 31S5A610_295

Page 296: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The diagrams in this section giveyou the dimensions and capacities ofyour Honda, and the locations of theidentification numbers. It alsoincludes information you shouldknow about your vehicle’s tires andemissions control systems.

................Identification Numbers . 294................................Specifications . 296

DOT Tire Quality Grading.............................(U.S. Cars) . 298

.................................Treadwear . 298......................................Traction . 298

.............................Temperature . 299.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 300

......Driving in Foreign Countries . 301

.......................Emissions Controls . 302.....................The Clean Air Act . 302

Crankcase Emissions Control....................................System . 302

Evaporative Emissions Control....................................System . 302

Onboard Refueling Vapor................................Recovery . 302

...Exhaust Emissions Controls . 303....................PGM-FI System . 303

Ignition Timing Control................................System . 303

Exhaust Gas Recirculation...................(EGR) System . 303

Three Way Catalytic...........................Converter . 303

....................Replacement Parts . 303..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 304

..............State Emissions Testing . 305

Technical Information

Technical Information 293

01/06/02 17:32:41 31S5A610_296

Page 297: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Your car has several identifyingnumbers located in various places.

The Vehicle Identification Number(VIN) is the 17-digit number yourHonda dealer uses to register yourcar for warranty purposes. It is alsonecessary for licensing and insuringyour car. The easiest place to findthe VIN is on a plate fastened to thetop of the dashboard. You can see itby looking through the windshieldon the driver’s side. It is also on theCertification label attached to thedriver’s doorjamb, and is stamped onthe engine compartment bulkhead.The VIN is also provided in bar codeon the Certification label.

Identif ication Numbers

Technical Information294

VVEEHHIICCLLEE IIDDEENNTTIIFFIICCAATTIIOONN NNUUMMBBEERR

CCEERRTTIIFFIICCAATTIIOONN LLAABBEELL

01/06/02 17:32:46 31S5A610_297

Page 298: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The Engine Number is stamped intothe engine block.

The Transmission Number is on alabel on top of the transmission.

Identif ication Numbers

Technical Information 295

EENNGGIINNEE NNUUMMBBEERR

MMAANNUUAALL TTRRAANNSSMMIISSSSIIOONNNNUUMMBBEERR

AAUUTTOOMMAATTIICC TTRRAANNSSMMIISSSSIIOONN NNUUMMBBEERR

01/06/02 17:32:53 31S5A610_298

Page 299: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

* *

***

**

Specifications

Technical Information296

Dimensions

Weights

Engine

Capacities

174.6 in (4,435 mm)67.3 in (1,710 mm)56.9 in (1,445 mm)103.1 in (2,620 mm)57.9 in (1,470 mm)57.9 in (1,470 mm)

2.95 x 3.72 in (75.0 x 94.4 mm)

13.2 US gal (50 , 11.0 Imp gal)

1.03 US gal (3.9 , 0.86 Imp gal)

102 cu-in (1.668 cm )9.59.9

LengthWidthHeightWheelbaseTrack

Gross vehicle weight rating See the certification label attachedto the driver’s doorjamb.

Type

Bore x StrokeDisplacementCompression ratio

Spark plugs

Water cooled 4-strokeSOHC , SOHC VTEC

4-cylinder gasoline engine

Fuel tank

Enginecoolant

Engine oil

Automatictransmissionfluid

1.06 US gal (4.0 , 0.88 Imp gal)

1.35 US gal (5.1 , 1.12 Imp gal)1.32 US gal (5.0 , 1.10 Imp gal)

3.4 US qt (3.2 , 2.8 Imp qt)3.7 US qt (3.5 , 3.1 Imp qt)3.2 US qt (3.0 , 2.6 Imp qt)3.5 US qt (3.3 , 2.9 Imp qt)4.4 US qt (4.2 , 3.7 Imp qt)1.6 US qt (1.5 , 1.3 Imp qt)1.7 US qt (1.6 , 1.4 Imp qt)2.9 US qt (2.7 , 2.4 Imp qt)6.2 US qt (5.9 , 5.2 Imp qt)

2.6 US qt (2.5 , 2.2 Imp qt)4.8 US qt (4.5 , 4.0 Imp qt)

Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in theengine.Reserve tank capacity: 0.11 US gal (0.4 , 0.09 Imp gal)Excluding the oil remaining in the engine.

See spark plug maintenancesection page 229 .

FrontRear

Approx.

1 :

2 :3 :4 :

1 : DX, LX2 : EX

DX, LXEX

ChangeManualAutomatic

TotalManualAutomatic

Change

Without filter

TotalChangeTotalChangeTotal

U.S. CarsCanada Cars

1 2

1

2

1

2

3

4

3

4

Manual trans-mission fluid

Including filter

Windshieldwasher reservoir

01/06/02 17:33:13 31S5A610_299

Page 300: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

- -

**

--

---

---------

* *

Specifications

Technical Information 297

Battery

Fuses

Tires

Alignment

Lights

Air Conditioning

HFC-134a (R-134a)17.6 19.4 oz (500 550 g)

SP-10

12 V12 V

60/55 W (HB2)21/5 W

60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )12 V 5 W12 V 8 W12 V 5 W12 V 5 W12 V 8 W12 V 3 CP12 V 21 W12 V 3 CP12 V 21 W

12 V 21/5 W12 V 21 W12 V 3 CP

12 V 36 AH/5 HRCapacity

Interior

Under-hood

Size

Pressure

Toe-in

Camber

Caster 1°33’0°50’0°

0.00 in (0.0 mm)

30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm )

T115/70D14 88MP185/65R15 86HP185/70R14 87S

Headlights (HI/LO)Front turn signal/side markerlightsFront parking lightRear turn signal lightsStop/Taillights/Rear sidemarker lightsBack-up lightsTaillightsHigh-mount brake lightLicense plate lightsCeiling lightFront ceiling lightSpotlights

Trunk light

Refrigerant typeCharge quantityLubricant oil type

0.08 in (2.0 mm)

T125/70D15 95M

See page 289 or the fuse labelattached to the inside of the fusebox door under the steeringcolumn.See page 288 or the fuse boxcover.

FrontRearFrontRearFront

1 : EX2 : LX

Front/Rear

Spare

Front/RearSpare

1 : US: DX, LXCanada: DX

2 : US: EXCanada: LX

3 : US: DX, LX without ABSCanada: DX

4 : US: EX, LX with ABSCanada: LX

1

2

1 3

4

1

2

01/06/02 17:33:37 31S5A610_300

Page 301: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

-The treadwear grade is a compara-tive rating based on the wear rate ofthe tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified governmenttest course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on thegovernment course as a tire graded100. The relative performance oftires depends upon the actual condi-tions of their use, however, and maydepart significantly from the normdue to variations in driving habits,service practices and differences inroad characteristics and climate.

The traction grades, from highest tolowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Thosegrades represent the tire’s ability tostop on wet pavement as measuredunder controlled conditions onspecified government test surfacesof asphalt and concrete. A tiremarked C may have poor tractionperformance.

The tires on your car meet all U.S.Federal Safety Requirements. Alltires are also graded for treadwear,traction, and temperature perform-ance according to Department ofTransportation (DOT) standards.The following explains thesegradings.

All passenger car tires must conformto Federal Safety Requirements inaddition to these grades.

Quality grades can be found whereapplicable on the tire sidewallbetween the tread shoulder and themaximum section width. Forexample:

Warning: The traction gradeassigned to this tire is based onstraight-ahead braking traction tests,and does not include acceleration,cornering, hydroplaning, or peaktraction characteristics.

DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Cars)

Technical Information

Treadwear Traction AA, A, B, C

Treadwear 200Traction AATemperature A

Uniform Tire Quality Grading

298

01/06/02 17:33:48 31S5A610_301

Page 302: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

-The temperature grades are A (thehighest), B, and C, representing thetire’s resistance to the generation ofheat and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlledconditions on a specified indoorlaboratory test wheel. Sustained hightemperature can cause the materialof the tire to degenerate and reducetire life, and excessive temperaturecan lead to sudden tire failure. Thegrade C corresponds to a level ofperformance which all passenger cartires must meet under the FederalMotor Vehicle Safety Standard No.109. Grades B and A representhigher levels of performance on thelaboratory test wheel than theminimum required by law.

Warning: The temperature grade forthis tire is established for a tire thatis properly inflated and not over-loaded. Excessive speed, underinfla-tion, or excessive loading, eitherseparately or in combination, cancause heat buildup and possible tirefailure.

DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Cars)

Technical Information

Temperature A, B, C

299

01/06/02 17:33:53 31S5A610_302

Page 303: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Some conventional gasolines arebeing blended with alcohol or anether compound. These gasolinesare collectively referred to asoxygenated fuels. To meet clean airstandards, some areas of the UnitedStates and Canada use oxygenatedfuels to help reduce emissions.

If you use an oxygenated fuel, besure it is unleaded and meets theminimum octane rating requirement.

Before using an oxygenated fuel, tryto confirm the fuel’s contents. Somestates/provinces require thisinformation to be posted on thepump.

If you notice any undesirableoperating symptoms, try anotherservice station or switch to anotherbrand of gasoline.

Fuel system damage or performanceproblems resulting from the use ofan oxygenated fuel containing morethan the percentages of oxygenatesgiven above are not covered underwarranty.

(ethyl or grain alcohol)You may use gasoline containing upto 10 percent ethanol by volume.Gasoline containing ethanol may bemarketed under the name ‘‘Gasohol.’’

The following are the U.S. EPA andCanadian CGSB approvedpercentages of oxygenates:

(Methyl Tertiary ButylEther)You may use gasoline containing upto 15 percent MTBE by volume.

(methyl or woodalcohol)Your vehicle was not designed to usefuel that contains methanol.Methanol can corrode metal parts inthe fuel system, and also damageplastic and rubber components. Thisdamage would not be covered byyour warranties.

Technical Information

Oxygenated Fuels

ETHANOL

MTBE

METHANOL

300

01/06/02 17:34:03 31S5A610_303

Page 304: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

If you are planning to take yourHonda outside the U.S. or Canada,contact the tourist bureaus in theareas you will be traveling in to findout about the availability of unleadedgasoline with the proper octanerating.

If unleaded gasoline is not available,be aware that using leaded gasolinein your Honda will affect perfor-mance and fuel mileage, and damageits emissions controls. It will nolonger comply with U.S. andCanadian emissions regulations, andwill be illegal to operate in NorthAmerica. To bring your car back intocompliance will require the replace-ment of several components, such asthe oxygen sensors and the threeway catalytic converter. These re-placements are not covered underwarranty.

Driving in Foreign Countries

Technical Information 301

01/06/02 17:34:08 31S5A610_304

Page 305: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

In Canada, Honda vehicles complywith the Canadian Motor VehicleSafety Standards (CMVSS) forEmissions valid at the time they aremanufactured.

The United States Clean Air Actsets standards for automobileemissions. It also requires thatautomobile manufacturers explain toowners how their emissions controlswork and what to do to maintainthem. This section summarizes howthe emissions controls work.Scheduled maintenance is on page

.

The burning of gasoline in your car’sengine produces several byproducts.Some of these are carbon monoxide(CO), oxides of nitrogen (NOx) andhydrocarbons (HC). Gasolineevaporating from the tank alsoproduces hydrocarbons. Controllingthe production of NOx, CO, and HCis important to the environment.Under certain conditions of sunlightand climate, NOx and HC react toform photochemical ‘‘smog.’’ Carbonmonoxide does not contribute tosmog creation, but it is a poisonousgas.

Your car has a Positive CrankcaseVentilation System. This keepsgasses that build up in the engine’scrankcase from going into theatmosphere. The Positive CrankcaseVentilation valve routes them from

the crankcase back to the intakemanifold. They are then drawn intothe engine and burned.

As gasoline evaporates in the fueltank, an evaporative emissionscontrol canister filled with charcoaladsorbs the vapor. It is stored in thiscanister while the engine is off. Afterthe engine is started and warmed up,the vapor is drawn into the engineand burned during driving.

The Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery (ORVR) system capturesthe fuel vapors during refueling. Thevapors are adsorbed in a canisterfilled with activated carbon. Whiledriving, the fuel vapors are drawninto the engine and burned off.

200

The Clean Air Act

Crankcase Emissions ControlSystem

Evaporative Emissions ControlSystem

Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery

Technical Information

Emissions Controls

302

01/06/02 17:34:19 31S5A610_305

Page 306: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The emissions control systems arecovered by warranties separate fromthe rest of your car. Read yourwarranty manual for more informa-tion.

The emissions control systems aredesigned and certified to work to-gether in reducing emissions tolevels that comply with the Clean AirAct. To make sure the emissionsremain low, you should use only newGenuine Honda replacement parts ortheir equivalent for repairs. Usinglower quality parts may increase theemissions from your car.

The exhaust emissions controlsinclude three or four systems: PGM-FI, Ignition Timing Control, ExhaustGas Recirculation (SOHC VTECengine only), and Three WayCatalytic Converter. These three orfour systems work together tocontrol the engine’s combustion andminimize the amount of HC, CO, andNOx that comes out the tailpipe. Theexhaust emissions control systemsare separate from the crankcase andevaporative emissions controlsystems.

The PGM-FI System uses sequentialmultiport fuel injection.It has three subsystems: Air Intake,Engine Control, and Fuel Control.The Engine Control Module (ECM)or the Powertrain Control Module(PCM) uses various sensors todetermine how much air is goinginto the engine. It then controls how

much fuel to inject under all operat-ing conditions.

This system constantly adjusts theignition timing, reducing the amountof HC, CO and NOx produced.

The Exhaust Gas Recirculation(EGR) system takes some of theexhaust gas and routes it back intothe intake manifold. Adding exhaustgas to the air/fuel mixture reducesthe amount of NOx produced whenthe fuel is burned.

The three way catalytic converter isin the exhaust system. Throughchemical reactions, it converts HC,CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaustto carbon dioxide (CO ), dinitrogen(N ), and water vapor.

2

2

On EX model only

Replacement PartsExhaust Emissions Controls

Emissions Controls

Technical Information

PGM-FI System

Ignition Timing Control System

Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)System

Three Way Catalytic Converter

303

01/06/02 17:34:32 31S5A610_306

Page 307: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

The three way catalytic convertercontains precious metals that serveas catalysts, promoting chemicalreactions to convert the exhaustgasses without affecting the metals.The catalytic converter is referred toas a three-way catalyst, since it actson HC, CO, and NOx. A replacementunit must be an original Honda partor its equivalent.

Always use unleaded gasoline.Even a small amount of leadedgasoline can contaminate thecatalyst metals, making the threeway catalytic converter ineffective.

The three way catalytic convertermust operate at a high temperaturefor the chemical reactions to takeplace. It can set on fire any com-bustible materials that come near it.Park your car away from high grass,dry leaves, or other flammables.

A defective three way catalyticconverter contributes to air pollution,and can impair your engine’s per-formance. Follow these guidelines toprotect your car’s three way catalyticconverter.

Keep the engine tuned-up.

Have your car diagnosed andrepaired if it is misfiring, back-firing, stalling, or otherwise notrunning properly.

(EX) (DX, LX)

Technical Information

Three Way Catalytic Converter

304

TTHHRREEEE WWAAYY CCAATTAALLYYTTIICC CCOONNVVEERRTTEERR TTHHRREEEE WWAAYY CCAATTAALLYYTTIICC CCOONNVVEERRTTEERR

01/06/02 17:34:41 31S5A610_307

Page 308: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

If you take your vehicle for a stateemissions test shortly after thebattery has been disconnected orgone dead, it may not pass the test.This is because of certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that must be set in the on-board diagnostics for the emissionssystems. These codes are erasedwhen the battery is disconnected,and set again only after several daysof driving under a variety ofconditions.

If the testing facility determines thatthe readiness codes are not set, youwill be requested to return at a laterdate to complete the test. If you mustget the vehicle re-tested within thenext two or three days, you cancondition the vehicle for re-testingby doing the following.

Make sure the gas tank is nearly,but not completely, full (around3/4).

Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 8hours or more.

Make sure the ambienttemperature is between 20° and95°F.

Without touching the acceleratorpedal, start the engine and let itidle for 20 seconds.

Keep the vehicle in Park(automatic transmission) orNeutral (manual transmission).Increase the engine speed to 2,000rpm and hold it there until thetemperature gauge rises to at least1/4 of the scale (approximately 3minutes).

Technical Information

Testing of Readiness Codes

State Emissions Testing

305

01/06/02 17:34:51 31S5A610_308

Page 309: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Then drive in city/suburbantraffic for at least 10 minutes.When traffic conditions allow, letthe vehicle coast for severalseconds without using theaccelerator pedal or the brakepedal.

If the testing facility determines thereadiness codes are still not set, seeyour Honda dealer.

Select a nearby lightly traveledmajor highway where you canmaintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph(80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20minutes. Drive on the highway inD (A/T) or 5th (M/T). Do not usethe cruise control. When trafficallows, drive for 90 secondswithout moving the acceleratorpedal. (Vehicle speed may varyslightly; this is okay.) If you cannotdo this for a continuous 90seconds because of trafficconditions, drive for at least 30seconds, then repeat it two moretimes (for a total of 90 seconds).

Technical Information

State Emissions Testing

306

01/06/02 17:34:58 31S5A610_309

Page 310: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Customer Relations................................Information . 308

....................Warranty Coverages . 309Reporting Safety Defects

..........................(U.S. Vehicles) . 310.....................Authorized Manuals . 311

Warranty and Customer Relations

Warranty and Customer Relations 307

01/06/02 17:35:01 31S5A610_310

Page 311: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

When you call or write, please giveus this information:

Honda dealership personnel aretrained professionals. They shouldbe able to answer all your questions.If you encounter a problem that yourdealership does not solve to yoursatisfaction, please discuss it withthe dealership’s management. TheService Manager or GeneralManager can help. Almost allproblems are solved in this way.

Vehicle Identification Number(see page )Name and address of the dealerwho services your carDate of purchaseMileage on your carYour name, address, and tele-phone numberA detailed description of theproblemName of the dealer who sold thecar to you

If you are dissatisfied with thedecision made by the dealership’smanagement, contact your HondaCustomer Relations Office.

U.S. Owners:

Canadian Owners:

In Puerto Rico and the U.S. VirginIslands:

294

Warranty and Customer Relations

Customer Relations Information

308

CUSTOMER RELATIONSRELATIONS AVEC LA CLIENTÈLE

Honda Canada Inc.715 Milner AvenueToronto, ONM1B 2K8

Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909

Toronto (416) 287-4776

Bella InternationalP.O. Box 190816San Juan, Puerto Rico 00919-0816

Tel: (787) 250-4318American Honda Motor Co.Honda Consumer AffairsDepartmentMail Stop 500-2N-7D1919 Torrance BoulevardTorrance, California 90501-2746

Tel: (800) 999-1009

01/06/02 17:35:12 31S5A610_311

Page 312: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

--

- -

Your new Honda is covered by thesewarranties:

provides proratedcoverage for a replacement batterypurchased from a Honda dealer.

a seatbelt that fails to function properly iscovered for the useful life of thevehicle.

covers all genuineHonda replacement parts againstdefects in materials and workman-ship.

Genuine Honda Accessories arecovered under this warranty. Timeand mileage limits depend on thetype of accessory and other factors.Please read your warranty manualfor details.

all exterior body panels arecovered for rust-through from theinside for the specified time periodwith no mileage limit.

providescoverage for as long as the pur-chaser of the muffler owns the car.

covers your new vehicle, except forthe battery, emissions controlsystems and accessories, againstdefects in materials andworkmanship.

this warranty gives upto 100 percent credit toward areplacement battery.

these twowarranties cover your vehicle’s emis-sions control systems. Time, mileage,and coverage are conditional. Pleaseread the warranty manual for exactinformation.

Restrictions and exclusions apply toall these warranties. Please read the2002 Honda Warranty Informationbooklet that came with your car forprecise information on warrantycoverages. Your Honda’s originaltires are covered by theirmanufacturer. Tire warranty infor-mation is in a separate booklet.

Please refer to the 2002 WarrantyManual that came with your car.

Replacement Battery LimitedWarranty

Seat Belt Limited Warranty

Replacement Parts LimitedWarranty

Accessory Limited Warranty

Rust Perforation Limited Warranty Replacement Muffler LifetimeLimited Warranty

New Vehicle Limited Warranty

Original Equipment Battery LimitedWarranty

Emissions Control Systems DefectsWarranty and EmissionsPerformance Warranty

U.S. Owners

Canadian Owners

Warranty Coverages

Warranty and Customer Relations 309

01/06/02 17:35:26 31S5A610_312

Page 313: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

To contact NHTSA, you may eithercall the Auto Safety Hotline toll-freeat 1-800-424-9393 (or 366-0123 inWashington D.C. area) or write to:NHTSA, U.S. Department ofTransportation, Washington,D.C. 20590. You can also obtainother information about motorvehicle safety from the Hotline.

If you believe that your vehicle has adefect which could cause a crash orcould cause injury or death, youshould immediately inform theNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration (NHTSA) in additionto notifying American Honda MotorCo., Inc.

If NHTSA receives similar com-plaints, it may open an investigation,and if it finds that a safety defectexists in a group of vehicles, it mayorder a recall and remedy campaign.However, NHTSA cannot becomeinvolved in individual problemsbetween you, your dealer, orAmerican Honda Motor Co., Inc.

Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles)

Warranty and Customer Relations310

01/06/02 17:35:32 31S5A610_313

Page 314: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

*2002

HON

The following publications covering the operation andservicing of your vehicle can be obtained from HelmIncorporated, either by filling out the attached form or,for credit card holders, calling the toll-free phone numberon the form. For manuals prior to the year shown below,contact Helm Incorporated, P.O. Box 07280, Detroit,Michigan 48207, or call 1-800-782-4356.

Valid only for sales within the U.S. Canadian owners shouldcontact their authorized Honda dealer.

Authorized Manuals

Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals(U.S. only)

311

ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-782-4356

OR

(NOTE: For Credit Card Holder Orders Only)

MINIMUM CREDIT CARD PURCHASE $10.00

Publication

Form Number

61S5A03

61S5A03EL

61S5A30

31S5A610

HON-R

Form Description

2001 2002 Honda Civic 2/4 Door

Service Manual

2001 2002 Honda Civic 2/4 Door

Electrical Troubleshooting Manual

2001 2002 Honda Civic 2/4 Door

Body Repair Manual

2002 Honda Civic 4 Door

Owner’s Manual

Order Form for Previous Years-

Indicate Year and Model Desired

Price

Each

$68.00

$48.00

$42.00

$32.00

FREE

PUBLICATION NUMBERVEHICLE MODEL

Name YearQty

Price

Each

Total

Price

GRAND TOTAL

HANDLING CHARGE

Mich. Purchases

Add 6% Sales Tax

TOTAL MATERIAL

$6.00

Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurringobligation.

Monday-Friday 8:00 A.M. 6:00 P.M. EST

By completing this form you can order the materials desired. You canpay by check or money order, or charge to your credit card. Mail toHelm Incorporated at the address shown on the back of the order form.

Prices are subject to change withoutnotice and without incurring obligation.

Orders are mailed within 10 days. Pleaseallow adequate time for delivery.

01/06/02 17:35:44 31S5A610_314

Page 315: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

SHIP

TO

PAYMENT

This manual describes the procedures involved in thereplacement of damaged body parts.

This manual covers maintenance and recommendedprocedures for repair to engine and chassis components.It is written for the Journeyman mechanic, but is simpleenough for most mechanically-inclined owners to under-stand.

This manual complements the Service Manual byproviding in-depth troubleshooting information for eachelectrical circuit in your vehicle.

Authorized Manuals

Service Manual:

Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:

Body Repair Manual:

312

NOTE: Dealers and Companies please provide dealer or company name,and also the name of the person to whose attention the shipment shouldbe sent. For purchases outside U.S.A. please write to the address shownbelow for a quotation.

P.O. BOX 07280·DETROIT, MICHIGAN 48207·1-800-782-4356

Customer Name Attention

Apartment Number

State & Zip CodeCity

Daytime Telephone Number

Check or money order enclosed payable to Helm Inc U.S. funds only.Do not send cash

MasterCard

VISA Check here if your billing address is differentfrom the shipping address shown above.

Account Number Expiration: Mo. Yr.

CUSTOMER SIGNATURE DATE

Street Address No P.O. Box Number

( )

These Publications cannot be returned for credit without receiving advance authorization within 14days of delivery. On returns, a restocking fee may be applied against the original order.

01/06/02 17:35:56 31S5A610_315

Page 316: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

BatteryCharging System

...........................Indicator . 62, 280............................Jump Starting . 274

..............................Maintenance . 230............................Specifications . 297

..............................Before Driving . 163....................................Belts, Seat . 8, 45

.............................Beverage Holder . 99.................................Body Repairs . 264

Brakes...........Anti-lock System (ABS) . 189

.............Break-in, New Linings . 164....................Bulb Replacement . 250

...........................................Fluid . 222.........................................Parking . 97

.................System Indicator . 62, 283........................Wear Indicators . 188

.............................Braking System . 188........................Break-in, New Car . 164

..Brightness Control, Instruments . 71........................Brights, Headlights . 70

Bulb Replacement..........................Back-up Lights . 251

..............................Brake Lights . 250

..............................Ceiling Light . 254................Front Parking Lights . 248

........Front Side Marker Lights . 248.................................Headlights . 247

.........High-mount Brake Light . 251.................License Plate Lights . 252

.........Rear Side Marker Lights . 250............................Specifications . 297

...................................Spotlights . 255...............................Trunk Light . 253

...Accessories and Modifications . 171................................Accessories . 171

.Additional Safety Precautions . 172............................Modifications . 172

ACCESSORY (Ignition Key.......................................Position) . 81

.............Accessory Power Socket . 101....................Additives, Engine Oil . 210

.............................Airbag (SRS) . 10, 48.....................Air Cleaner Element . 225

..............Air Conditioning System . 106..............................Maintenance . 234

.........................................Usage . 106.......................Air Outlets (Vents) . 108.......................Air Pressure, Tires . 238

..................High Speed Driving . 239.........................Normal Driving . 239.......................Alcohol in Gasoline . 300

......................................Antifreeze . 213Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)

...............................Indicator . 62, 191...................................Operation . 189

..............Anti-theft, Audio System . 157

Anti-theft Steering Column..............................................Lock . 80

..........................Appearance Care . 257................Audio System . 114, 126, 138

...Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners . 46.............Automatic Speed Control . 159..............Automatic Transmission . 182

..........................Capacity, Fluid . 296...............Checking Fluid Level . 220

.......................................Shifting . 183.Shift Lever Position Indicator . 182

................Shift Lever Positions . 183....................Shift Lock Release . 186

Index

A

B

I

01/06/02 17:36:02 31S5A610_316

Page 317: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

................DANGER, Explanation of . ii...................................Dashboard . 2, 58

................Daytime Running Lights . 71............Defects, Reporting Safety . 310

........................Defog and Defrost . 111................Defogger, Rear Window . 75..............Defrosting the Windows . 111

....................................Dimensions . 296...............Dimming the Headlights . 70

Dipstick..........Automatic Transmission . 220

..................................Engine Oil . 168..........................Directional Signals . 72

........Disc Brake Wear Indicators . 188.....................Disposal of Used Oil . 212

Doors..............Locking and Unlocking . 81

......................Power Door Locks . 82..........DOT Tire Quality Grading . 298

............................Capacities Chart . 296.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 54

.............................Carrying Cargo . 173Cassette Player

............................................Care . 156...................Operation . 120, 132, 153

..............CAUTION, Explanation of . ii..................CD Changer . 123, 135, 149

......................CD Player . 123, 135, 147..................................Ceiling Light . 102

........................Certification Label . 294............................................Chains . 244

....................Changing a Flat Tire . 267............Changing Engine Coolant . 215

Changing Oil........................................How to . 211......................................When to . 200

...Charging System Indicator . 62, 280............Checklist, Before Driving . 178

.....................................Child Safety . 22

Child Seats......LATCH Anchorage System . 43

...........................Lower Anchors . 43..........Tether Anchorage Points . 42

..................Childproof Door Locks . 86....................Cleaner Element, Air . 225

Cleaning......................................Exterior . 258.......................................Interior . 260

...................................Seat Belts . 261...........................................Vinyl . 261

....................................Windows . 262.........Clock, Setting the . 119, 131, 143

...................................Clutch Fluid . 223........................CO in the Exhaust . 302

............Cold Weather, Starting in . 179..............................Compact Spare . 266

...............Consumer Information . 308.............Controls, Instruments and . 57

Coolant........................................Adding . 213

....................................Checking . 169.........................Proper Solution . 213

...................................Replacing . 215...................Temperature Gauge . 68

....................Corrosion Protection . 263

Crankcase Emissions Control........................................System . 302

............Cruise Control Operation . 159..........Customer Relations Office . 308

Bulb Replacement....................Turn Signal Lights . 248

..............................Bulbs, Halogen . 247

Index

CD

II

01/06/02 17:36:08 31S5A610_317

Page 318: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

Downshifting, 5-speed Manual.............................Transmission . 180

.....................................Drive Belts . 237...........Driver and Passenger Safety . 5

...........................................Driving . 177....................................Economy . 170

.........................In Bad Weather . 192................In Foreign Countries . 301

..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 235

..............................Economy, Fuel . 170............Emergencies on the Road . 265.............Battery, Jump Starting . 274...........Brake System Indicator . 283

................Changing a Flat Tire . 267.....Charging System Indicator . 280

..................Checking the Fuses . 286.....Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 279...Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 281...Manually Closing Moonroof . 284

..................Overheated Engine . 276...........................Emergency Brake . 97

......................Emergency Flashers . 74......................Emergency Towing . 290

............Emergency Trunk Opener . 87.......................Emissions Controls . 302

.............Emissions Testing, State . 305Engine

....Coolant Temperature Gauge . 68.................................Drive Belts . 237

......Engine Speed Limiter . 181, 185Malfunction Indicator

................................Lamp . 63, 281........Oil Pressure Indicator . 62, 279..............Oil, What Kind to Use . 209

...............................Overheating . 276............................Specifications . 296

.......................................Starting . 179......................Ethanol in Gasoline . 300

.Evaporative Emissions Controls . 302...............................Exhaust Fumes . 54

Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat........................................Belts by . 20

..................Exterior, Cleaning the . 258

............................Fabric, Cleaning . 261...................................Fan, Interior . 106

Features, Comfort and

..............................Convenience . 105....................Filling the Fuel Tank . 165

Filters................................Air Cleaner . 225

.........................Dust and pollen . 235...............................................Oil . 211

5-speed Manual Transmission...............Checking Fluid Level . 221

................................Shifting the . 180.............Flashers, Hazard Warning . 74

...................Flat Tire, Changing a . 267Fluids

..........Automatic Transmission . 220..........................................Brake . 222.........................................Clutch . 223

..............Manual Transmission . 221..........................Power Steering . 224

..................Windshield Washer . 219FM Stereo Radio

...................................Reception . 145...........................Folding Rear Seat . 91

.....Foreign Countries, Driving in . 301..........................Four-way Flashers . 74

............................Front Airbags . 10, 48

Index

E

F

III

01/06/02 17:36:15 31S5A610_318

Page 319: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

.................................................Fuel . 164......................Fill Door and Cap . 165

...........................................Gauge . 67................Octane Requirement . 164

...............................Oxygenated . 300........................Reserve Indicator . 63

........................Tank, Filling the . 165.....................Fuses, Checking the . 285

...............Gas Mileage, Improving . 170..........................................Gasohol . 300.........................................Gasoline . 164

...............Fuel Reserve Indicator . 63...........................................Gauge . 67

................Octane Requirement . 164........................Tank, Filling the . 165

................Gas Station Procedures . 165Gauges

...Engine Coolant Temperature . 68...............................................Fuel . 67

...............................Speedometer . 66.................................Tachometer . 66

Gearshift Lever Positions..........Automatic Transmission . 183

5-speed Manual.........................Transmission . 180

..............................Glass Cleaning . 262........................................Glove Box . 98

.............Halogen Headlight Bulbs . 247..............Hazard Warning Flashers . 74

Headlights........................................Aiming . 247

............Daytime Running Lights . 71..................High Beam Indicator . 63

........................Reminder Beeper . 70........Replacing Halogen Bulbs . 247

...................................Turning on . 70..............................Head Restraints . 90

.....................Heating and Cooling . 106.............High Altitude, Starting at . 179

.................High-Low Beam Switch . 70..............High-mount Brake Light . 251

....................................Hood Latch . 226.......................Hood, Opening the . 166

..................................................Horn . 69...........................Hydraulic Clutch . 223

.................................Hydroplaning . 193

...Identification Number, Vehicle . 294Ignition

..............................................Keys . 77...........................................Switch . 80

............Timing Control System . 303.........Important Safety Precautions . 6

Indicators, Instrument.............................................Panel . 59

...............................Infant Restraint . 31Infant Seats

......LATCH Anchorage System . 43...........................Lower Anchors . 43

..........Tether Anchorage Points . 42...................Inflation, Proper Tire . 238..................High Speed Driving . 239

.........................Normal Driving . 239...................................Inside Mirror . 96

.............................Inspection, Tire . 240........................Instrument Panel . 2, 58

........Instrument Panel Brightness . 71...........................Interior Cleaning . 260

...............................Interior Lights . 102........................................Introduction . i

Index

G

H

I

IV

01/06/02 17:36:21 31S5A610_319

Page 320: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

..................................................Keys . 77

........................Jacking up the Car . 268.......................................Jack, Tire . 267

................................Jump Starting . 274

..................................Maintenance . 195...Owner Maintenance Checks . 207

.................................Record . 205-206......................Required Indicator . 64

..........................................Safety . 196.............................Schedule . 198-204

.Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 63, 281...................Manual Transmission . 180

........Manual Transmission Fluid . 221...............................Meters, Gauges . 66

...................Methanol in Gasoline . 300..........................Mirrors, Adjusting . 96

.........................................Moonroof . 95......................Closing Manually . 284

.....................................Operation . 95

...Octane Requirement, Gasoline . 164.........................................Odometer . 66

...............................Odometer, Trip . 67Oil

........................Change, How to . 211......................Change, When to . 200......................Checking Engine . 168..............Pressure Indicator . 62, 279

Selecting Proper Viscosity......................................Chart . 210

...........ON (Ignition Key Position) . 81Onboard Refueling Vapor

....................................Recovery . 302

...................Neutral Gear Position . 184..................New Vehicle Break-in . 164

.....................Normal Shift Speeds . 181...................NOTICE, Explanation of . i

...............Numbers, Identification . 294

.......................Label, Certification . 294.................Lane Change, Signaling . 72

..................Lap/Shoulder Belts . 16, 45...........LATCH Anchorage System . 43

Lights....................Bulb Replacement . 247

.......................................Indicator . 59.........................................Parking . 70

..................................Turn Signal . 72.....................................Load Limit . 174

......LOCK (Ignition Key Position) . 80Locks

.......Anti-theft Steering Column . 80............................Fuel Fill Door . 165

.................................Power Door . 82...........................................Trunk . 86

........................Low Coolant Level . 169.........................Low Fuel Indicator . 63

................................Lower Anchors . 43...Lower Gear, Downshifting to a . 181

...Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 62, 279...Lubricant Specifications Chart . 296

.........................................Luggage . 173

Index

L M

N

O

J

K

V

01/06/02 17:36:30 31S5A610_320

Page 321: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

..Operation in Foreign Countries . 301..............................Outside Mirrors . 96

....................Overheating, Engine . 276.......Owner Maintenance Checks . 207

.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 300

...................Radiator Overheating . 276Radio/CD/Cassette

...........Sound System . 114, 126, 138

...................Readiness Codes . 282, 305Rear Lights, Bulb

......................Replacement . 250, 251..........................Rear Seat, Folding . 91

............................Rear View Mirror . 96.................Rear Window Defogger . 75...............Reclining the Seat Backs . 88

.......Recommended Shift Speeds . 181.............................Reminder Lights . 59

.......................Remote Transmitter . 83Replacement Information

.................Air Cleaner Element . 225..............Dust and Pollen Filter . 235

..........................Engine Coolant . 215................Engine Oil and Filter . 211

..........................................Fuses . 286................................Light Bulbs . 247

....................................Schedule . 198................................Spark Plugs . 227................................Timing Belt . 237

...........................................Tires . 242.............................Wiper Blades . 232

Replacing Seat Belts After a............................................Crash . 47

Reserve Tank, Engine...............................Coolant . 169, 213

...............................Restraint, Child . 22..................Reverse Gear Position . 184

................................Rotation, Tire . 241

..................................Safety Belts . 8, 45.........Safety Defects, Reporting . 310

.................................Safety Features . 7.........................................Airbags . 10

..................................Door Locks . 11..........................Head Restraints . 11

.......................................Seat Belts . 8.....................Seats & Seat-Backs . 11

.............Safety Labels, Location of . 55

..............................Paint Touch-up . 259..............Panel Brightness Control . 71

........................Park Gear Position . 183...........................................Parking . 187

.................................Parking Brake . 97Parking Brake and Brake System

.......................................Indicator . 62.................................Parking Lights . 70

..Parking Over Things that Burn . 304.............................PGM-FI System . 303

..................Polishing and Waxing . 259............Pre-Drive Safety Checklist . 12

.........Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts . 20............................Protecting Adults . 13

...Additional Safety Precautions . 20.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 20

........................Protecting Children . 22.......................Protecting Infants . 31

.......Protecting Larger Children . 38.........Protecting Small Children . 35

Using Child Seats with.....................................Tethers . 42

.............................Using LATCH . 43

Index

P R

S

VI

01/06/02 17:36:36 31S5A610_321

Page 322: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

CONTINUED

.....................................Tachometer . 66Taillights, Changing

..................................Bulbs . 250, 251.Taking Care of the Unexpected . 265

...................Tape Player . 120, 132, 153

...............................Safety Messages . ii.....................................Seat Belts . 8, 45

...............Additional Information . 45Automatic Seat Belt

...............................Tensioners . 46.....................................Cleaning . 261

................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 16, 45................................Maintenance . 47

......Reminder Light and Beeper . 61...................System Components . 45

...............Use During Pregnancy . 20...Wearing a Lap/Shoulder Belt . 16

........................Seats, Adjusting the . 88...............................Serial Number . 294

...........................Service Intervals . 198

...........................Service Manual . 311.........Service Station Procedures . 165

..........Setting the Clock . 119, 131, 143.....Shift Lever Position Indicator . 182

........................Shift Lock Release . 186..............................Side Airbags . 10, 50

...................Cut-off Indicator . 52, 61Side Marker Lights, Bulb

......................Replacement . 248, 250...............................Signaling Turns . 72

.....................................Snow Tires . 243

...................Solvent-type Cleaners . 258................Sound System . 114, 126, 138

Spare Tire......................................Inflating . 266

............................Specifications . 297................Spark Plugs, Replacing . 227

....................Specifications Charts . 296................................Speed Control . 159...................................Speedometer . 66

.......................................Spotlights . 103..........SRS, Additional Information . 48

...Additional Safety Precautions . 53.............................Airbag Service . 53

How the Side Airbag Cut-off...........Indicator Light Works . 52

How the SRS Indicator.......................................Works . 51

How Your Front Airbags.........................................Work . 48

...How Your Side Airbags Work . 50........................SRS Components . 48

.............................SRS Indicator . 51, 61....START (Ignition Key Position) . 81

..............State Emissions Testing . 305

.......................Starting the Engine . 179In Cold Weather at High

..................................Altitude . 179................With a Dead Battery . 274

........Steam Coming from Engine . 276Steering Wheel

..................................Adjustment . 76.............Anti-theft Column Lock . 80

...Stereo Sound System . 114, 126, 138...........................Storing Your Car . 256

Supplemental Restraint................................System . 10, 48......................................Servicing . 53

.........................SRS Indicator . 51, 61...................System Components . 48

..................................Synthetic Oil . 210

Index

T

VII

01/06/02 17:36:42 31S5A610_322

Page 323: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

.................Vehicle Capacity Load . 174......................Vehicle Dimensions . 296

....Vehicle Identification Number . 294.............................Vehicle Storage . 256

.....................................Ventilation . 109.................................................VIN . 294

...............................Vinyl Cleaning . 261..................................Viscosity, Oil . 210

.............WARNING, Explanation of . ii.........Warning Labels, Location of . 55

..................Warranty Coverages . 309Washer, Windshield

........Checking the Fluid Level . 219.......................................Indicator . 63

Technical Descriptions......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 298.....Emissions Control Systems . 302

.....................Oxygenated Fuels . 300Three Way Catalytic

...............................Converter . 304.......................Temperature Gauge . 68

..............Tether Anchorage Points . 42............................Theft Protection . 157

..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 304..........Time, Setting the . 119, 131, 143

....................................Timing Belt . 237

....................................Tire Chains . 244.........Tire, How to Change a Flat . 267

...............................................Tires . 238..............................Air Pressure . 238

.........................Checking Wear . 240..........................Compact Spare . 266

......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 298......................................Inflation . 238

..................................Inspection . 240..............................Maintenance . 240

...................................Replacing . 242......................................Rotating . 241

...........................................Snow . 243............................Specifications . 297

................................Tire Chains . 244...................Tools, Tire Changing . 267

Towing.....................................A Trailer . 193

..................Emergency Towing . 290...........................Traction Devices . 244

TransmissionChecking Fluid Level,

..............................Automatic . 220Checking Fluid Level,

...................................Manual . 221..................Fluid Selection . 220, 221

..............Identification Number . 295.............Shifting the Automatic . 183

..................Shifting the Manual . 180.....................................Treadwear . 298.......................................Trip Meter . 67

................................................Trunk . 86........................................Opening . 86

...................Open Monitor Light . 63....................................Turn Signals . 72

.....................Underside, Cleaning . 263

Unexpected, Taking Care..........................................of the . 265

....Uniform Tire Quality Grading . 298........................Unleaded Gasoline . 164

.....................Upholstery Cleaning . 260.......Used Oil, How to Dispose of . 212

Index

U

W

V

VIII

01/06/02 17:36:49 31S5A610_323

Page 324: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

.....................................Operation . 74.........................................Washing . 258

..................Waxing and Polishing . 259Wheels

...............Adjusting the Steering . 76............Alignment and Balance . 240

..........................Compact Spare . 266......................................Wrench . 268

Windows.....................................Cleaning . 262

..................Operating the Power . 93...........................Rear, Defogger . 75

Windshield.......................................Cleaning . 72...................................Defroster . 111

.......................................Washers . 74Wipers, Windshield

.......................Changing Blades . 232.....................................Operation . 72

....................................Worn Tires . 240.....Wrecker, Emergency Towing . 290

: U.S. and Canada only

Index

IX

01/06/02 17:36:52 31S5A610_324

Page 325: 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610 001 Owner’sIdentificationowners.honda.com/assets/OWNERLINK/Model/own_man/... · 01/06/02 16:43:36 31S5A610_001 ... Congratulations Your selection of a

Service Information Summary

Gasoline:

Fuel Tank Capacity:

Recommended Engine Oil:Tire Pressure (measured cold):

Brake Fluid:

5-speed Manual TransmissionFluid:

Automatic Transmission Fluid:

Power Steering Fluid:

Unleaded gasoline, pump octanenumber of 86 or higher.

13.2 US gal (50 , 11.0 Imp gal)

30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm )

Honda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 orDOT 4 brake fluid as a temporaryreplacement (see page ).

Front/Rear:

Spare Tire:60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )

API Premium grade 5W-20detergent oil (see page ).

Oil change capacity (includingfilter):

3.4 US qt (3.2 , 2.8 Imp qt)

3.7 US qt (3.5 , 3.1 Imp qt)

Honda ATF-Z1 (AutomaticTransmission Fluid) preferred, ora DEXRON III ATF as atemporary replacement (see page

).

Honda Manual TransmissionFluid preferred, or an API serviceSG, SH or SJ, SAE 10W-30 or10W-40 motor oil as a temporaryreplacement (see page ).

Capacity (including differential):1.6 US qt (1.5 , 1.3 Imp qt)

Honda Power Steering Fluidpreferred, or another brand ofpower steering fluid as atemporary replacement. Do notuse ATF (see page ).

DX, LX

EX

220

221

224

222

209

01/06/02 17:37:12 31S5A610_325